blob: 1b42a3c39b643d312ce3d8b4252626d3203c5db0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau96a2f502021-06-30 16:16:14 +02007 2021/06/30
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200805Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
806See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
807
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200808The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
809expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100810
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
812 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200813 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200814 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200815 - a question mark ('!') preceeding any of the non-empty elements above, and
816 which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200817 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
818 from left to right until one returns false
819 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
820 from right to left until one returns true
821
822Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
823operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200824
825The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
826
827 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
828 exists, regardless of its contents
829
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200830 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
831 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
832 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
833
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200834 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
835 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
836
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200837 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
838 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
839 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
840 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
841
842 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
843 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
844 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
845 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
846
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200847Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200849 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
850 listen mwcli_px
851 bind :1111
852 ...
853 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100854
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
856 bind :80
857 .endif
858
859 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200860 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200861 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200863 .endif
864
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200865 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200866 bind :443 ssl crt ...
867 .endif
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
870 profiling.memory on
871 .endif
872
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200873 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
874 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
875 .endif
876
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200877Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100878
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200879 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
881 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
882 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
883
884Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
885"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
886fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
887provide advice to the user.
888
889Example:
890
891 .if "${A}"
892 .if "${B}"
893 .notice "A=1, B=1"
894 .elif "${C}"
895 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
896 .elif "${D}"
897 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
898 .else
899 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
900 .endif
901 .else
902 .notice "A=0"
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200905 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
906 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
907
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100908
9092.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200910----------------
911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100912Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
914otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
915numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
916for every keyword. Supported units are :
917
918 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
919 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
920 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
921 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
922 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
923 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
924
925
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009262.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200927-------------
928
929 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
930 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
931 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
932 global
933 daemon
934 maxconn 256
935
936 defaults
937 mode http
938 timeout connect 5000ms
939 timeout client 50000ms
940 timeout server 50000ms
941
942 frontend http-in
943 bind *:80
944 default_backend servers
945
946 backend servers
947 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
948
949
950 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
951 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
952 global
953 daemon
954 maxconn 256
955
956 defaults
957 mode http
958 timeout connect 5000ms
959 timeout client 50000ms
960 timeout server 50000ms
961
962 listen http-in
963 bind *:80
964 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
965
966
967Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
968
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100969 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200970
971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009723. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973--------------------
974
975Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
976are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
977of them have command-line equivalents.
978
979The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
980
981 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200982 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200984 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200987 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200988 - description
989 - deviceatlas-json-file
990 - deviceatlas-log-level
991 - deviceatlas-separator
992 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200993 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900994 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - gid
996 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100997 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200998 - h1-case-adjust
999 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001000 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001001 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001002 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001003 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001004 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001006 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001009 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001010 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001011 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001012 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001014 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001016 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001017 - presetenv
1018 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019 - uid
1020 - ulimit-n
1021 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001022 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001023 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001025 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-options
1030 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001031 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-options
1033 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001034 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001035 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001036 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001038 - 51degrees-data-file
1039 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001040 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001041 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001042 - wurfl-data-file
1043 - wurfl-information-list
1044 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001045 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001046 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001049 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001050 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001052 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001053 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001054 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001055 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001056 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001057 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001058 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001059 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060 - noepoll
1061 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001062 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001063 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001064 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001065 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001066 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001067 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001068 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001069 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001070 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001071 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001072 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001073 - tune.buffers.limit
1074 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001075 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001076 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001077 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001078 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001079 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001080 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001081 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001082 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001083 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001084 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001085 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001086 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001087 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001088 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1089 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001090 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001091 - tune.maxaccept
1092 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001093 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001094 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001095 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001096 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1097 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001098 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1099 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001100 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001101 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001102 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001103 - tune.sndbuf.client
1104 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001105 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001106 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001107 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001108 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001109 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001110 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001111 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001112 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001113 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001114 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001115 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1116 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1117 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001118 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1119 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001123 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124
1125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001127------------------------------------
1128
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001129ca-base <dir>
1130 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001131 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1132 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1133 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135chroot <jail dir>
1136 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1137 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1138 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1139 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1140 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001141 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001142
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001143cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001144 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1146 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1147 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1148 set. These sets have the format
1149
1150 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1151
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001152 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1153 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001154 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001155 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001156 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1157 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001158 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1159 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1160 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1161 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1162 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1163 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1164 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1165 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1166 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1167 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001168
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001169 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1170 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1171 on the machine's word size.
1172
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001173 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001174 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1175 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1176 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1177 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1178 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1179 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001180
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001181 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1182 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1183 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1184 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001186 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1188 # first 4 CPUs
1189
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001190 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1191 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001192 # word size.
1193
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001194 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1195 # and so on.
1196 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1197 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1199
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001200 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1201 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1202 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1203 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001204
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001205 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1206 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1207 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001208
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001209crt-base <dir>
1210 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001211 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1212 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001213
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214daemon
1215 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1216 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001217 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1218 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001220default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001221 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001222 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1223 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1224 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1225 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1226 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1227 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1228 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1229 not start with a slash ('/'):
1230 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1231 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1232
1233 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1234 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1235 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1236 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1237 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1238 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1239 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1240 each of them.
1241
1242 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1243 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1244 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1245 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1246 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1247 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1248 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1249 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1250
1251 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1252 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001253 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001254 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1255 made easily relocatable.
1256
1257 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1258 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1259 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1260 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1261 consistent across all configuration files.
1262
1263 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1264 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1265 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1266 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1267 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1268 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1269 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1270 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1271
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001272deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1273 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001274 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001275
1276deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001277 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001278 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1279
1280deviceatlas-separator <char>
1281 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1282 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1283
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001284deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001285 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1286 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1287 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001288
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001289expose-experimental-directives
1290 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1291 the config file will be rejected.
1292
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001293external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001294 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1295 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001296 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1297 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1298 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1299 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1300 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001301
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001303 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1305 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001306 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001307 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001308 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001309
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001310group <group name>
1311 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1312 See also "gid" and "user".
1313
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001314hard-stop-after <time>
1315 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1316
1317 Arguments :
1318 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1319 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1320 SIGUSR1 signal.
1321
1322 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1323 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1324 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1325
1326 Example:
1327 global
1328 hard-stop-after 30s
1329
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001330h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1331 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1332 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1333 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1334 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001335 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001336 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1337 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1338 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1339 specified in a proxy.
1340
1341 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1342 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1343 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1344 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1345 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1346 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1347 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1348
1349 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1350 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1351 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1352 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1353 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1354
1355 Example:
1356 global
1357 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1358
1359 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1360 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1361
1362h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1363 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1364 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1365 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1366 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1367 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1368 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1369 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1370 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1371
1372 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1373 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1374 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1375
1376 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1377 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1378
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001380 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001381 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1382 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1383 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1384 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1385 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1386 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1387 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001388 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001389 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1390 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1391 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1392 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1393 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1394 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1395 disable it.
1396
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001397insecure-setuid-wanted
1398 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1399 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1400 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1401 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001402 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001403 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001404 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001405 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1406 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001407 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001408 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1409 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1410 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1411 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1412
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001413issuers-chain-path <dir>
1414 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1415 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1416 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001417 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001418 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1419 "issuers-chain-path".
1420 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1421 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1422 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1423 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1424 will share the chain in memory.
1425
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001426h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1427 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1428 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1429 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1430 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1431 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1432 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1433 the keyword with "no'.
1434
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001435localpeer <name>
1436 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1437 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1438 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1439 the configuration parsing.
1440
1441 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1442 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1443
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001444log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001445 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001446 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001447 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001448 configured with "log global".
1449
1450 <address> can be one of:
1451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001452 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001453 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1454 port).
1455
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001456 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1457 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1458 port).
1459
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001460 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001461 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1462 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001463 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001464
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001465 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1466 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1467 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1468 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1469 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1470 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1471 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1472 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1473 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1474 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001475 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001476 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1477 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1478 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001479 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1480 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001481
1482 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1483 "fd@2", see above.
1484
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001485 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1486 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1487 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1488 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1489 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1490
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001491 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1492 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001493
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001494 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1495 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1496 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1497 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1498 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1499 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1500 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1501 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1502 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1503 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001504 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1505 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001506
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001507 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1508 one of the following :
1509
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001510 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1511 field is stripped. This is the default.
1512 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1513 rfc3164.
1514
1515 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001516 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1517
1518 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1519 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1520
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001521 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1522 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1523 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1524 designed to be used with a local log server.
1525
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001526 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1527 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1528 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1529 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1530 logger consumes.
1531
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001532 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1533 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1534 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1535 used with a local log server.
1536
1537 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1538 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1539 designed to be used with a local log server.
1540
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001541 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1542 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1543 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1544 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1545
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001546 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1547 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1548 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1549 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1550 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1551
1552 <sample_size>
1553 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1554 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1555 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1556 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1557 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1558
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001559 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001560
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001561 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1562 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1563 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1564
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001565 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1566 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1567 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1568 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
1570 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001571 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1572 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1573 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1574 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1575 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1576 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001578 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001580log-send-hostname [<string>]
1581 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1582 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1583 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1584 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1585 the logs.
1586
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001587log-tag <string>
1588 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1589 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1590 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001591 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001592
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001593lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001594 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1595 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1596 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1597 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1598 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1599 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001600 used multiple times.
1601
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001602lua-load-per-thread <file>
1603 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1604 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1605 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1606 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1607 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1608 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1609 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1610 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1611 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1612 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1613 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1614 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1615 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1616 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1617 times.
1618
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001619lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1620 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1621 variable.
1622 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1623 to "path".
1624
1625 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1626 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1627 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1628 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1629 will be checked earlier.
1630
1631 As an example by specifying the following path:
1632
1633 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1634 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1635
1636 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1637 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1638 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1639 paths if that does not exist either.
1640
1641 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1642 documentation.
1643
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001644master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001645 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1646 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1647 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001648 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001649 or daemon mode.
1650
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001651 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1652 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1653 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1654 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1655 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001656
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001657 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001658
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001659mworker-max-reloads <number>
1660 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001661 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001662 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1663 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1664 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1665
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001666nbthread <number>
1667 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001668 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1669 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1670 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1671 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1672 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1673 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1674 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001675
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001676numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001677 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001678 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1679 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1680 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1681 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1682 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1683 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1684 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1685 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001688 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1689 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1690 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1691 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001693pp2-never-send-local
1694 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1695 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1696 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1697 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1698 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1699 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1700 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1701 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1702 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1703 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1704 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1705
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001706presetenv <name> <value>
1707 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1708 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1709 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1710 and "unsetenv".
1711
1712resetenv [<name> ...]
1713 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1714 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1715 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1716 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1717 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1718 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1719 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1720 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1721
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001722stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001723 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1724 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1725 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001726
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001727server-state-base <directory>
1728 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001729 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1730 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001731
1732server-state-file <file>
1733 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1734 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1735 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1736 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1737 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1738 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1739 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1740 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001741 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1742 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001743
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001744set-var <var-name> <expr>
1745 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1746 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1747 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1748 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1749 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1750 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1751 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1752 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1753 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1754
1755 Example:
1756 global
1757 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1758 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1759 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1760
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001761setenv <name> <value>
1762 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1763 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1764 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1765 and "unsetenv".
1766
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001767set-dumpable
1768 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001769 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1770 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1771 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1772 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1773 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1774 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1775 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1776 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1777 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1778 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1779 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1780 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1781 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1782 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1783 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001784 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001785 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001786
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001787ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1789 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001790 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001791 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001792 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1793 information and recommendations see e.g.
1794 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1795 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1796 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1797 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001798
1799ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1801 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1802 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1803 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1804 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001805 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1806 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1807 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001808 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001809
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001810ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1812 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1813 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1814 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1815 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1816
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001817ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1819 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1820 keyword to see available options.
1821
1822 Example:
1823 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001824 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001825
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001826ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1828 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001829 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001830 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001831 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1832 information and recommendations see e.g.
1833 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1834 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1835 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1836 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1837 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001838
1839ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1841 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1842 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1843 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1844 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001845 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1846 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1847 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1848 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001849
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001850ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1852 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1853 keyword to see available options.
1854
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001855ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1857 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1858 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001859 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001860 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001861 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1862 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1863 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1864 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001865 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1866 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1867 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1868
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001869ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1870 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1871 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001872 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001873 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001874 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1875
1876 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001877
1878 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1879 and won't try to remove them.
1880
1881 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1882
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001883ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001884 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001885 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1886 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1887 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001888
1889 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1890 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1891 optimize the startup time.
1892
1893 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1894 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1895 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1896
1897 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001898 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001899
1900 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001901 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1902 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001903
1904 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1905 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1906 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1907 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1908 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001909 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001910
1911 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001912 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001913 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1914 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1915 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1916 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1917 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001918 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001919
1920 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1921
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001922 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001923 a cert bundle.
1924
1925 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1926 separately in several "crt".
1927
1928 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1929 since files are loading separately.
1930
1931 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1932 required to commit them.
1933
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001934 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001935 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001936
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001937 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1938 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1939 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001940
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001941 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1942 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1943 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001944
1945 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001946 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1947 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001949 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1950 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1951
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001952 The default behavior is "all".
1953
1954 Example:
1955 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1956 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1957 ssl-load-extra-files none
1958
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001959 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1960 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001962ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1963 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1964 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1965 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1966
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001967ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001968 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001969 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1970 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1971 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1972 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1973 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1974 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001975 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001976
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001977stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1978 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1979 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1980 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001981 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001982 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001983
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001984 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1985 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1986 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001987
1988stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1989 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1990 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001991 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001992
1993stats maxconn <connections>
1994 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1995 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1996
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001997uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001998 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2000 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2001 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2002
2003ulimit-n <number>
2004 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2005 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2006 option.
2007
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002008unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2009 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2010
2011 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2012 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2013 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2014 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2015 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002016 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002017 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2018 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2019 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2020 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2021
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002022unsetenv [<name> ...]
2023 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2024 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2025 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2026 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2027 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2028 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2029 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2030
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002031user <user name>
2032 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2033 See also "uid" and "group".
2034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002035node <name>
2036 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2037
2038 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2039 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2040 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2041 traffic.
2042
2043description <text>
2044 Add a text that describes the instance.
2045
2046 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2047 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2048 "<" and ">" characters.
2049
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205051degrees-data-file <file path>
2051 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002053
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002054 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002055 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2056
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000205751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002058 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2059 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2060 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2061
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002062 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002063 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2064
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200206551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002066 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2067 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2068
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002069 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002070 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2071
207251degrees-cache-size <number>
2073 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2074 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2075 By default, this cache is disabled.
2076
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002077 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002078 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2079
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002080wurfl-data-file <file path>
2081 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2082 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2083
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002084 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002085 with USE_WURFL=1.
2086
2087wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2088 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2089 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2090 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2091
2092 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2093
2094 Valid WURFL properties are:
2095 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2096
2097 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2098 device.
2099
2100 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2101 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2102
2103 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2104 particular web request.
2105
2106 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2107 used Libwurfl API version.
2108
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002109 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2110 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2111
2112 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2113 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2114
2115 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2116
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002117 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002118 with USE_WURFL=1.
2119
2120wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2121 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2122 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002124 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002125 with USE_WURFL=1.
2126
2127wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2128 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2129 thus before the chroot.
2130
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002131 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002132 with USE_WURFL=1.
2133
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002134wurfl-cache-size <size>
2135 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2136 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002137 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002138 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002139
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002140 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002141 with USE_WURFL=1.
2142
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002143strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002144 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002145 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2146 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002147 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002148 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021503.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002151-----------------------
2152
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002153busy-polling
2154 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2155 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2156 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2157 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2158 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2159 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2160 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2161 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2162 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2163 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2164 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2165 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2166 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2167 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2168 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2169 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2170 "poll" pollers.
2171
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002172 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2173 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2174 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2175
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002176max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002177 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002178 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2179 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2180 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2181 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2182 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2183 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2184 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186maxconn <number>
2187 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2188 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2189 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002190 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2191 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2192 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2193 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002194 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2195 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2196 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2197 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2198 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2199 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002200
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002201maxconnrate <number>
2202 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2203 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2204 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2205 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2206 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2207 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2208 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2209 fairness.
2210
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002211maxcomprate <number>
2212 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002213 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002214 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2215 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2216 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002217 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002218 default value.
2219
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002220maxcompcpuusage <number>
2221 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2222 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2223 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002224 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2225 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2226 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2227 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002228
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002229maxpipes <number>
2230 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2231 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2232 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2233 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2234 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2235 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2236
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002237maxsessrate <number>
2238 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2239 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2240 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2241 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2242 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2243 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2244 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2245 fairness.
2246
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002247maxsslconn <number>
2248 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2249 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2250 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2251 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2252 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2253 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2254 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002255 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2256 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2257 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2258 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002259 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002260 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2261 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002262
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002263maxsslrate <number>
2264 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2265 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2266 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2267 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2268 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2269 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2270 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2271 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2272 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2273 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2274
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002275maxzlibmem <number>
2276 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2277 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2278 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002279 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2280 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2281 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2282
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002283noepoll
2284 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2285 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002286 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287
2288nokqueue
2289 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2290 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2291 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2292
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002293noevports
2294 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2295 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2296 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2297 also "nopoll".
2298
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299nopoll
2300 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2301 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002303 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2304 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002306nosplice
2307 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002308 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002309 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002310 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002311 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2312 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2313 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2314 "option splice-response".
2315
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002316nogetaddrinfo
2317 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2318 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2319
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002320noreuseport
2321 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2322 command line argument "-dR".
2323
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002324profiling.memory { on | off }
2325 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2326 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2327 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2328 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2329 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2330 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2331 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2332 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2333 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2334
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002335profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2336 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2337 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2338 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2339 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002340 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002341 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2342 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2343 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2344 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2345
2346 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2347 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2348 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2349 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2350 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002351 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2352 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2353 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2354 CLI.
2355
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002356spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002357 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2358 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2359 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2360 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2361 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2362 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002364ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002365 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002366 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002367 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002368 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002369 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2370 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2371 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002372 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2373 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002374 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2375 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2376 openssl configuration file uses:
2377 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2378
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002379ssl-mode-async
2380 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002381 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002382 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2383 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002384 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002385 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002386 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002387
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002388tune.buffers.limit <number>
2389 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2390 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2391 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2392 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2393 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002394 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002395 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2396 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2397 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2398 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2399 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2400 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2401 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2402 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002403 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002404
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002405tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2406 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2407 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2408 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002409 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002410
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002411tune.bufsize <number>
2412 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2413 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2414 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2415 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2416 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2417 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2418 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002419 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2420 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002421 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002422 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002424 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2425 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002426
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002427tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2428 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2429 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2430 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2431 this value. The default value is 1.
2432
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002433tune.fail-alloc
2434 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2435 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2436 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2437 gracefully.
2438
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002439tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2440 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2441 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2442 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2443 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2444 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2445
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002446tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2447 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2448 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2449 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2450 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2451 change it.
2452
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002453tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2454 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002455 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002457 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2458 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2459 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2460 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2461 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2462
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002463tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2464 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2465 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2466 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2467 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2468 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002469 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002470 recommended not to change this value.
2471
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002472tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002473 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002474 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002476 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2477 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2478 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2479 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2480
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002481tune.http.cookielen <number>
2482 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2483 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2484 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2485 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2486 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2487 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2488 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2489 to change this value.
2490
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002491tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002492 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2493 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002494 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002495 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002496 configuration directives too.
2497 The default value is 1024.
2498
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002499tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2500 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2501 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2502 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2503 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2504 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2505 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002506 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2507 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2508 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002509
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002510tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2511 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2512 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2513 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2514 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2515 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2516 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002517 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2518 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2519 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2520 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2521 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002522
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002523tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002524 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002525 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2526 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2527 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2528 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002529 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002530 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002531 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002532 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2533
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002534tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2535 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2536 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2537 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2538 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2539 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2540 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2541 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2542 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2543 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2544
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002545tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2546 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002547 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002548 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2549 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002550 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002551 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2552 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2553
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002554tune.lua.maxmem
2555 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2556 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2557 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2558 memory.
2559
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002560tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2561 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002562 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2563 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002564 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002565
2566tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2567 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2568 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2569 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2570 check servers.
2571
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002572tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2573 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2574 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2575 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002576 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002577
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002578tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002579 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2580 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002581 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2582 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2583 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2584 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2585 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2586 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2587 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2588 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2589 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002590
2591tune.maxpollevents <number>
2592 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2593 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2594 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2595 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2596 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2597
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002598tune.maxrewrite <number>
2599 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2600 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2601 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2602 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2603 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2604 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2605 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2606 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2607 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2608 bufsize.
2609
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002610tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2611 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2612 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2613 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2614 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2615 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2616 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2617 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2618 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2619 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002620 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2621 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002622 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2623 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2624 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2625 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2626 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2627 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2628 setting this parameter to 0.
2629
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002630tune.pipesize <number>
2631 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2632 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2633 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2634 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2635 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2636 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2637
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002638tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2639 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002640 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002641 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2642 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2643 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2644 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002645 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002646
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002647tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2648 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002649 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002650 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2651 default is 20.
2652
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002653tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2654tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2655 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2656 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2657 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002658 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002659 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002660 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2661 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2662
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002663tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002664 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002665 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2666 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2667 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2668 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2669
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002670tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002671 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002672 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2673 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2674 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2675 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2676 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2677 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2678 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002679
2680tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2681 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002683 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2684 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2685 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2686 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2687 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2688 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2689 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002690
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002691tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2692tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2693 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2694 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2695 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002696 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002697 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002698 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2699 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2700 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2701 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002702 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002703
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002704tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002705 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002706 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2707 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2708 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2709 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2710 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2711 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2712 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2713 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2714 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002715 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2716 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002717
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002718tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002719 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002720 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2721 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2722 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2723 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2724 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2725
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002726tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2727 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2728 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2729 performances. This is disabled by default.
2730
2731 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2732 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2733
2734 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2735
2736 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2737
2738 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2739
2740 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2741 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2742 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2743
2744 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2745 converted.
2746
2747 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2748 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2749 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2750 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2751 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2752 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2753 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002754 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2755 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002756
2757 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2758
2759 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2760 only need this line:
2761
2762 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2763
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002764tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2765 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002766 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002767 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2768 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2769 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2770 being used for too long.
2771
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002772tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2773 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2774 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2775 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2776 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2777 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2778 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2779 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2780 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2781 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2782 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002783 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002784 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002785
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002786tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2787 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2788 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2789 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2790 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002791 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002792 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2793 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002794 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2795 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002796
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002797tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2798 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2799 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2800 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2801 1000 entries.
2802
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002803tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2804 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2805 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2806 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002808tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002809tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002810tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2811tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2812tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002813 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2814 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2815 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2816 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2817 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2818 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2819 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2820 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002821
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002822 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2823 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2824 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2825 all available space is consumed.
2826 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2827 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2828 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002829
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002830tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2831 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002832 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002833 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002834 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002835 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2836
2837tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2838 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2839 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002840 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2841 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028433.3. Debugging
2844--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002846quiet
2847 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2848 line argument "-q".
2849
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002850zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002851 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002852 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2853 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2854 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2855 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2856 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2857
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028593.4. Userlists
2860--------------
2861It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2862http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2863it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2864
2865userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002866 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002867 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2868
2869group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002870 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002871 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2872 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2873
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002874user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2875 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002876 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2877 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002878 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2879 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2880 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2881 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002882
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002883 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2884 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2885 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2886 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2887 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2888 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2889 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002890 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002891 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002892
2893 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002894 userlist L1
2895 group G1 users tiger,scott
2896 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002897
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002898 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2899 user scott insecure-password elgato
2900 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002901
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 userlist L2
2903 group G1
2904 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2907 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2908 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
2910 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002912
29133.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002914----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002915It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002916several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002917instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2918values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2919automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2920In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2921using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2922tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2923reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2924Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2925that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2926each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002927
2928peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002929 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002930 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2931
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002932bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2933 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2934 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2935
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002936disabled
2937 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2938 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2939 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2940
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002941default-bind [param*]
2942 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2943
2944default-server [param*]
2945 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2946
2947 Arguments:
2948 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2949 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2950 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2951 details.
2952
2953
2954 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2955
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002956enable
2957 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2958
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002959log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002960 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2961 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2962 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2963 more details.
2964
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002965peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002966 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2967 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002968 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002969 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002970 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2971 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2972 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2975 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2976
2977 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002978 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2979 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2980 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002982 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2983 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002984
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002985 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2986 "server" keyword explanation below).
2987
2988server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002989 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002990 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2991 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2992 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2993 of this "peers" section).
2994 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2995
2996
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002997 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002998 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003000 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3001 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3002 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003003
3004 backend mybackend
3005 mode tcp
3006 balance roundrobin
3007 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3008 stick on src
3009
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003010 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3011 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003013 Example:
3014 peers mypeers
3015 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3016 default-server ssl verify none
3017 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3018 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003019
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003020
3021table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3022 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3023
3024 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3025 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003026 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003027 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3028 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3029 "stick-table" keyword).
3030
3031 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3032 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3033 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3034 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3035 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3036 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3037 of the stick-table name as follows:
3038
3039 peers mypeers
3040 peer A ...
3041 peer B ...
3042 table t1 ...
3043
3044 frontend fe1
3045 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3046
3047 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3048 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3049
3050 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3051 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3052 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3053 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3054 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3055 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3056 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3057
3058 peers mypeers
3059 peer A ...
3060 peer B ...
3061 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3062
3063 backend t1
3064 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3065
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003066 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003067 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3068 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3069
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030703.6. Mailers
3071------------
3072It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3073If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3074in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3075
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003076mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003077 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3078 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3079
3080mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3081 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3082
3083 Example:
3084 mailers mymailers
3085 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3086 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3087
3088 backend mybackend
3089 mode tcp
3090 balance roundrobin
3091
3092 email-alert mailers mymailers
3093 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3094 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3095
3096 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3097 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3098
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003099timeout mail <time>
3100 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3101 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3102 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3103 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3104
3105 Example:
3106 mailers mymailers
3107 timeout mail 20s
3108 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003109
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031103.7. Programs
3111-------------
3112In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3113master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3114managed the same way as the workers.
3115
3116During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3117sequence as a worker:
3118
3119 - the master is re-executed
3120 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3121 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3122 instance of the program
3123
3124During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3125
3126program <name>
3127 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3128 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3129 the management guide).
3130
3131command <command> [arguments*]
3132 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3133 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3134 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3135 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3136
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003137user <user name>
3138 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3139 See also "group".
3140
3141group <group name>
3142 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3143 See also "user".
3144
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003145option start-on-reload
3146no option start-on-reload
3147 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3148 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3149 program section.
3150
3151
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031523.8. HTTP-errors
3153----------------
3154
3155It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3156imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3157several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3158
3159http-errors <name>
3160 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3161 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3162
3163errorfile <code> <file>
3164 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3165
3166 Arguments :
3167 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003168 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003169 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003170
3171 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3172 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3173 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3174 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3175 before any chroot is performed.
3176
3177 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3178
3179 Example:
3180 http-errors website-1
3181 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3182 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3183 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3184
3185 http-errors website-2
3186 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3187 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3188 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3189
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031903.9. Rings
3191----------
3192
3193It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3194servers or traces.
3195
3196ring <ringname>
3197 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3198
3199description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003200 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003201 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3202
3203format <format>
3204 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3205
3206 Arguments:
3207 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3208 one of the following :
3209
3210 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3211 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3212 designed to be used with a local log server.
3213
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003214 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3215 field is stripped. This is the default.
3216 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3217 rfc3164.
3218
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003219 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3220 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3221 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3222 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3223 is the default.
3224
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003225 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003226 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3227
3228 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3229 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3230
3231 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3232 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3233 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3234 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3235 logger consumes.
3236
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003237 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3238 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3239 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3240 with a local log server.
3241
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003242 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3243 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3244 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3245 used with a local log server.
3246
3247maxlen <length>
3248 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3249 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3250 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3251
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003252server <name> <address> [param*]
3253 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3254 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3255 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3256 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3257 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3258 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3259 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3260 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3261 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003262 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3263 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003264
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003265size <size>
3266 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3267 set to BUFSIZE.
3268
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003269timeout connect <timeout>
3270 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3271
3272 Arguments :
3273 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3274 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3275 as explained at the top of this document.
3276
3277timeout server <timeout>
3278 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3283 as explained at the top of this document.
3284
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003285 Example:
3286 global
3287 log ring@myring local7
3288
3289 ring myring
3290 description "My local buffer"
3291 format rfc3164
3292 maxlen 1200
3293 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003294 timeout connect 5s
3295 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003296 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003297
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032983.10. Log forwarding
3299-------------------
3300
3301It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003302HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003303
3304log-forward <name>
3305 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3306
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003307backlog <conns>
3308 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3309 on connections accept.
3310
3311bind <addr> [param*]
3312 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003313 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3314 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3315 syslog protocol over TCP.
3316 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003317 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3318
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003319dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003320 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3321 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3322 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3323 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003324 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003325
3326log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003327log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003328 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3329 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3330 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003331 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003332 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3333 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3334 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003335 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003336
3337 Example:
3338 global
3339 log stderr format iso local7
3340
3341 ring myring
3342 description "My local buffer"
3343 format rfc5424
3344 maxlen 1200
3345 size 32764
3346 timeout connect 5s
3347 timeout server 10s
3348 # syslog tcp server
3349 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3350
3351 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003352 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3353 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003354 # all messages on stderr
3355 log global
3356 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3357 log ring@myring local0
3358 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3359 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3360 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3361 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3362 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003363
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003364maxconn <conns>
3365 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3366 10 is the default.
3367
3368timeout client <timeout>
3369 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033714. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003372----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003374Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003375 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3376 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3377 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3378 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003379
3380A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3381connections.
3382
3383A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3384to forward incoming connections.
3385
3386A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3387parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3388
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003389A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3390ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3391sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3392the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3393explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3394from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3395"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3396for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3397to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3398optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3399are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3400any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3401names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3402that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3403duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3404names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3405
3406Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3407settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3408of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3409profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3410timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3411
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3413'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3414case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3415
3416Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3417logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3418proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3419However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3420name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3421
3422Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3423and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003424bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3426modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3427arbitrary criteria.
3428
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003429In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3430a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003431the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003432
3433 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3434 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3435 between responses and new requests.
3436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3438 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3439 client-facing connection remains open.
3440
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003441 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3442 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003443
3444The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3445frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3446following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003447weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003448
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003451 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3452 ----+-----+-----+----
3453 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3454 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3456 ----+-----+-----+----
3457 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003458
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003459It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003460only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3461within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003462as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003463content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003464and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3465possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003467There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003468first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003469processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003470second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003471protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3472is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3473new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003474to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3476already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3477HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3478evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3479one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3480
3481There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3482performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3483tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3484preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3485analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3486HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3487header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3488mitigate this drawback.
3489
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003490There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003491method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3492set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3493in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3494is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3495to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3496above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3497to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3498"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3499frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3500frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3501as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3502upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3503on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3504the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3505upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3506frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3507remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3510--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003512The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3513limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3514they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3515limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003516marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003517option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003518and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3519with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3520specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003523 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3524------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3525acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003526backlog X X X -
3527balance X - X X
3528bind - X X -
3529bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003530capture cookie - X X -
3531capture request header - X X -
3532capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003533clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3534clitcpka-idle X X X -
3535clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003536compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003537cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003538declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003539default-server X - X X
3540default_backend X X X -
3541description - X X X
3542disabled X X X X
3543dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003544email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003545email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003546email-alert mailers X X X X
3547email-alert myhostname X X X X
3548email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003549enabled X X X X
3550errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003551errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003552errorloc X X X X
3553errorloc302 X X X X
3554-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3555errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003556force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003557filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003558fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003560http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003561http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003562http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003563http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003564http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003565http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003566http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003567http-check set-var X - X X
3568http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003569http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003571http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003572http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003573http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003575ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003576load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003577log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003578log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003579log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003580log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003581max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582maxconn X X X -
3583mode X X X X
3584monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585monitor-uri X X X -
3586option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3587option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3588option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3589option allbackups (*) X - X X
3590option checkcache (*) X - X X
3591option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3592option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003593option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3595option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3597option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003598option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003600option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003601option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003602option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003603option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003604option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3606option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3607option httpchk X - X X
3608option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003609option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003610option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003611option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003612option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003613option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3615option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3616option logasap (*) X X X -
3617option mysql-check X - X X
3618option nolinger (*) X X X X
3619option originalto X X X X
3620option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003621option pgsql-check X - X X
3622option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003624option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003625option smtpchk X - X X
3626option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3627option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3628option splice-request (*) X X X X
3629option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003630option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3632option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003634option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003635option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3636option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3637option tcpka X X X X
3638option tcplog X X X X
3639option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003640external-check command X - X X
3641external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003642persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3643rate-limit sessions X X X -
3644redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003647retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003649server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003650server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003652srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3653srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3654srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003655stats admin - X X X
3656stats auth X X X X
3657stats enable X X X X
3658stats hide-version X X X X
3659stats http-request - X X X
3660stats realm X X X X
3661stats refresh X X X X
3662stats scope X X X X
3663stats show-desc X X X X
3664stats show-legends X X X X
3665stats show-node X X X X
3666stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3668stick match - - X X
3669stick on - - X X
3670stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003671stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003672stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003673tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003674tcp-check connect X - X X
3675tcp-check expect X - X X
3676tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003677tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003678tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003679tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003680tcp-check set-var X - X X
3681tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003682tcp-request connection - X X -
3683tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003684tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003685tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003686tcp-response content - - X X
3687tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003688timeout check X - X X
3689timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003690timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3693timeout http-request X X X X
3694timeout queue X - X X
3695timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003696timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003698timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003700unique-id-format X X X -
3701unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003703use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003704use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3706 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037094.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3710---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003711
3712This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3713
3714
3715acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3716 Declare or complete an access list.
3717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 no | yes | yes | yes
3719 Example:
3720 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3721 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3722 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003724 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725
3726
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003727backlog <conns>
3728 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | no
3731 Arguments :
3732 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3733 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003734 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003735
3736 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3737 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3738 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3739 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3740 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3741 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3742 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3743 backlog parameter.
3744
3745 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3746 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3747 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3748
3749 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3750
3751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003753balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | no | yes | yes
3757 Arguments :
3758 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3759 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3760 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3761 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3762
3763 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3764 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3765 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3766 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003767 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003768 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003769 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3770 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3771 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3772 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3773 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3774 it, so that you don't worry.
3775
3776 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3777 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3778 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3779 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3780 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3781 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3782 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3783 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003785 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3786 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3787 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3788 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3789 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3790 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3791 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003792 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3793 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3794 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003795
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003796 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003797 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003798 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3799 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003800 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003801 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3802 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3803 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3804 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3805 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003806 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3807 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3808 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3809 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3810 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3811 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3814 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3815 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3816 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3817 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3818 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3819 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3820 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003821 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003823 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3824 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3825 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003826
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003827 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3828 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3829 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3830 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3831 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3832 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3833 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3834 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3835 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3836 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3837 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3838 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003840 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003841 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3842 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3843 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3844 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3845 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3846 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3847 URIs start with a leading "/".
3848
3849 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3850 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3851 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3852 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3853
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003854 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3855 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3856 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3857 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003860 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3861
3862 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003863 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3864 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003865 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3866 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3867 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3868 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003869 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003870 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3871 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003872
3873 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3874 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3875 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3876 server will receive the request.
3877
3878 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3879 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3880 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3881 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3882 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003883 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3884 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3885 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003886
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003887 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3888 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3889 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3890 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3891 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003893 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003894 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3895 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3896 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3897
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003898 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3899 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3900 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3901
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003902 random
3903 random(<draws>)
3904 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003905 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3906 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3907 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3908 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003909 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3910 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3911 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3912 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3913 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3914 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3915 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3916 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3917 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3918 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3919 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3920 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3921 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3922 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3923 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3924 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3925 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3926 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3927 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3928 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003929
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003930 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003931 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003932 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3933 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3934 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3935 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3936 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3937 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003938 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003939 used instead.
3940
3941 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3942 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3943 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3944 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3945
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003946 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3947 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3948 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3949
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003950 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003953 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3954 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003955
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003956 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3957 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3958 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003960 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003961 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003962 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3963 NTLM relies on.
3964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965 Examples :
3966 balance roundrobin
3967 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003968 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003969 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3970 balance hdr(host)
3971 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003972
3973 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3974 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003977 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3978 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3979 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003980 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3983 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3984 defaults to 16 kB.
3985
3986 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3987 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3988
3989 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3990 Round Robin.
3991
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003992 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003993 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3994 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3995 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3996
3997 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3998
3999 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004000 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004001 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4002 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4003 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004005 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006
4007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004008bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4009bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004010 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 no | yes | yes | no
4013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004014 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4015 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4016 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4017 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004018 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004019 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4020 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4021 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4022 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4023 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4024 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004025 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004026 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4027 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004028 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004029 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4030 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004031 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004032 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4033 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004034 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004035 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004036 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4037 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4038 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004039 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4040 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4041 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4042 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004043 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4044 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4045 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004046
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004047 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4048 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004049 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4050 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4051 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004052 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4053 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4054 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4055 the range.
4056
4057 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4058 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4059 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4060 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4061 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4062 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4063 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004064 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004065 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004066
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004067 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004068 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004069 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4070 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4071 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4072 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4073 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4074 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4075
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004076 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4077 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4078 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4079 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004081 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4082 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4083 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4084 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4085 in a frontend.
4086
4087 Example :
4088 listen http_proxy
4089 bind :80,:443
4090 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004091 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004092
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004093 listen http_https_proxy
4094 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004095 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004096
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004097 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4098 bind ipv6@:80
4099 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4100 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4101
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004102 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004103 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004104
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004105 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4106 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4107 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4108 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4109 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4110
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004111 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004112 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113
4114
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004115bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4117 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004118
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004119 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4120 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4121 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4122 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4123 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4124 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004125
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004126 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004127
4128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129capture cookie <name> len <length>
4130 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 no | yes | yes | no
4133 Arguments :
4134 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4135 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4136 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4137 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004138 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004139
4140 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4141 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4142 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4143 right if it exceeds <length>.
4144
4145 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4146 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4147 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4148 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4149
4150 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4151 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4152 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4153
4154 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4155 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4156 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004157 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4158 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4159 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004160
4161 Example:
4162 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4163
4164 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004165 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004166
4167
4168capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004169 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4171 no | yes | yes | no
4172 Arguments :
4173 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004174 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4176 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4177 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4178
4179 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4180 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4181 it exceeds <length>.
4182
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004183 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004184 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4185 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004186 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4187 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4188 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4189 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004190 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004191 environments to find where the request came from.
4192
4193 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4194 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4195 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4196 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004197
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004198 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4199 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4200 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4201 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4202 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004203
4204 Example:
4205 capture request header Host len 15
4206 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004207 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004209 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004210 about logging.
4211
4212
4213capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004214 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 no | yes | yes | no
4217 Arguments :
4218 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004219 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004220 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4221 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4222 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4223
4224 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4225 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4226 it exceeds <length>.
4227
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004228 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004229 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4230 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4231 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004232 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4233 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4234 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4235 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004237 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4238 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4239 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4240 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4241 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242
4243 Example:
4244 capture response header Content-length len 9
4245 capture response header Location len 15
4246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004247 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004248 about logging.
4249
4250
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004251clitcpka-cnt <count>
4252 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4253 the connection on the client side.
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 yes | yes | yes | no
4256 Arguments :
4257 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4258
4259 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4260 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004261 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4262 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004263
4264 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4265
4266
4267clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4268 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4269 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4270 client side.
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | yes | yes | no
4273 Arguments :
4274 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4275 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4276 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4277 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4278
4279 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4280 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004281 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4282 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004283
4284 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4285
4286
4287clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4288 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | yes | yes | no
4291 Arguments :
4292 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4293 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4294 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4295 document.
4296
4297 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4298 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004299 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4300 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004301
4302 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4303
4304
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004305compression algo <algorithm> ...
4306compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004307compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004308 Enable HTTP compression.
4309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 yes | yes | yes | yes
4311 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004312 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4313 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004314 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004315
4316 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004317 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4318 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4319 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004320
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004321 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004322 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004323
4324 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4325 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4326 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4327 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4328 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004329 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004330
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004331 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4332 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4333 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4334 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4335 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4336 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4337 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004338 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004339
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004340 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004341 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004342 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004343 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004344 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004345 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004346 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004347
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004348 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004349 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4350 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004351 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4352 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004353 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004354 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004355 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4356 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004357 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004358 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4359 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004360
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004361 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004362 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4363 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004364 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004365 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004366 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4367 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4368 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4369 "multipart"
4370 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4371 header
4372 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4373 and later
4374 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4375 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004376 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004377
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004378 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004379
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004380 Examples :
4381 compression algo gzip
4382 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004383
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004384
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004385cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004386 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4387 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004388 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4391 yes | no | yes | yes
4392 Arguments :
4393 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4394 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4395 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4396 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4397 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4398 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004399 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004400 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4401 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4402
4403 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004404 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004405 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4406 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4407 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4408 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004409 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4410 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004411 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004412 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4413 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004414
4415 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004416 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004417
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004418 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004419 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004420 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004421 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004422 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4423 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4424 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4425 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4426 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4427 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4428 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004429
4430 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4431 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4432 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4433 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4434 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4435 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4436 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4437 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4438 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004439 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004440 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4441 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4442 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004443
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004444 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4445 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4446 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004447 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4448 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4449 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4450 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004451 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4452 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4453 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004454
4455 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4456 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4457 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4458 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4459 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4460 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4461 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4462 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4463 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4464
4465 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4466 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4467 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4468 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4469 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4470 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4471 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4472 persistence cookie in the cache.
4473 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4474
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004475 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4476 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004477 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004478 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4479 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004480 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004481 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4482 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4483 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4484 they logout.
4485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004486 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004487 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4488 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4489 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4490
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004491 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004492 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4493 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4494 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4495 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4496 this attribute.
4497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004498 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004499 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004500 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4501 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4502 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4503 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4504 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4505 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004507 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4508 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4509 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4510 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4511 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4512 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4513 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4514 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004515 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004516 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4517 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4518 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4519 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4520 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4521 the site.
4522
4523 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4524 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4525 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4526 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4527 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4528 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4529 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4530 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4531 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4532 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4533 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4534 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4535 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004536 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004537 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4538 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4539
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004540 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4541 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4542 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4543 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4544 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4545 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4546
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004547 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004548 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4549 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4550 repeated.
4551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4553 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4554 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4555 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004557 Examples :
4558 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4559 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4560 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004561 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004563 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004564
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004565
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004566declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4567 Declares a capture slot.
4568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 no | yes | yes | no
4570 Arguments:
4571 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4572
4573 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4574 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4575 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4576 for use in the response.
4577
4578 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004579 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004580 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4581
4582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004583default-server [param*]
4584 Change default options for a server in a backend
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | no | yes | yes
4587 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004588 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4589 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4590 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4591 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004592
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004593 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004594 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4595
4596 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004597
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004599default_backend <backend>
4600 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4602 yes | yes | yes | no
4603 Arguments :
4604 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4605
4606 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4607 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4608 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4609 will catch all undetermined requests.
4610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611 Example :
4612
4613 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4614 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4615 default_backend dynamic
4616
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004617 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004619
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004620description <string>
4621 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 no | yes | yes | yes
4624 Arguments : string
4625
4626 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4627 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4628 it describes.
4629 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4630
4631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004632disabled
4633 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 yes | yes | yes | yes
4636 Arguments : none
4637
4638 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4639 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4640 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4641 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4642 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4643 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4644 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4645
4646 See also : "enabled"
4647
4648
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004649dispatch <address>:<port>
4650 Set a default server address
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004653 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004654
4655 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4656 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4657 during start-up.
4658
4659 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4660 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4661 possible with normal servers.
4662
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004663 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004664 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4665 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4666 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4667 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4668
4669 See also : "server"
4670
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004671
4672dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4673 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 yes | no | yes | yes
4676 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4677
4678 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004679 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004680 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4681 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004682 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004683 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004685enabled
4686 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 yes | yes | yes | yes
4689 Arguments : none
4690
4691 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4692 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4693
4694 See also : "disabled"
4695
4696
4697errorfile <code> <file>
4698 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 yes | yes | yes | yes
4701 Arguments :
4702 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004703 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004704 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004705
4706 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004707 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004709 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4710 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711
4712 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4713 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4714 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4715
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004716 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4717
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004718 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4719 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4720 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4721 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4722 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4723 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4724 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4725 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4726 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004728 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4729 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4730 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004731 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004732 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4733
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004734 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004735
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004736 Example :
4737 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004738 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004739 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4740 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4741
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004742
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004743errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4744 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4745 section.
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments :
4749 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4750
4751 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004752 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004753 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4754 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004755
4756 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4757 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4758 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4759 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4760 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004761 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004762 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4763
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004764 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4765 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004766
4767 Example :
4768 errorfiles generic
4769 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4770
4771
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004772errorloc <code> <url>
4773errorloc302 <code> <url>
4774 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | yes | yes | yes
4777 Arguments :
4778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004779 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004780 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004781
4782 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4783 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4784 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4785 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004786 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004787
4788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4793
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004794 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4795 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4796 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4797 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004798 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004799 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4800 request.
4801
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004802 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803
4804
4805errorloc303 <code> <url>
4806 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | yes | yes | yes
4809 Arguments :
4810 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004811 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004812 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004813
4814 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4815 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4816 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4817 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004818 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004819
4820 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4821 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4822 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4823
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004824 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4825
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004826 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4827 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4828 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4829 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004830 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004831
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004832 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004833
4834
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004835email-alert from <emailaddr>
4836 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004837 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | yes | yes | yes
4840
4841 Arguments :
4842
4843 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4844
4845 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4846 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4847
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004848 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004849 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4850 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004851
4852
4853email-alert level <level>
4854 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4855 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | yes
4858
4859 Arguments :
4860
4861 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4862 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4863 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4864
4865 By default level is alert
4866
4867 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4868 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4869 for the proxy.
4870
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004871 Alerts are sent when :
4872
4873 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4874 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4875 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4876 is notice or lower
4877 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4878 and a health check status update occurs
4879
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004880 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4881 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004882 section 3.6 about mailers.
4883
4884
4885email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4886 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889
4890 Arguments :
4891
4892 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4893
4894 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4895 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4896
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004897 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4898 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004899
4900
4901email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4902 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4903 mailers.
4904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | yes
4906
4907 Arguments :
4908
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004909 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004910
4911 By default the systems hostname is used.
4912
4913 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4914 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4915 for the proxy.
4916
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004917 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4918 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004919
4920
4921email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004922 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004923 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4925 yes | yes | yes | yes
4926
4927 Arguments :
4928
4929 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4930
4931 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4932 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4933
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004934 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004935 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4936
4937
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004938force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4939 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004941 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004942
4943 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4944 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4945 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4946 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4947 marked down for maintenance operations.
4948
4949 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4950 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4951 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4952 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4953 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4954 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4955 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4956 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4957 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4958
4959 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4960 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4961 is used.
4962
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004963 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004964 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004965
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004966
4967filter <name> [param*]
4968 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 no | yes | yes | yes
4971 Arguments :
4972 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4973 referenced in section 9.
4974
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004975 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004976 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004977 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4978 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004979
4980 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4981 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4982
4983 Example:
4984 listen
4985 bind *:80
4986
4987 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4988 filter compression
4989 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4990
4991 compression algo gzip
4992 compression offload
4993
4994 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4995
4996 See also : section 9.
4997
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004998
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004999fullconn <conns>
5000 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 yes | no | yes | yes
5003 Arguments :
5004 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5005 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5006
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005007 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005008 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005009 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005010 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5011 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5012 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5013 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5014 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005015 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005016
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005017 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005018 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005019 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5020 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5021 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005022
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005023 Example :
5024 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5025 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5026 # connections.
5027 backend dynamic
5028 fullconn 10000
5029 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5030 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5031
5032 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5033
5034
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005035hash-balance-factor <factor>
5036 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | no | no | yes
5039 Arguments :
5040 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5041 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005042 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005043
5044 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5045 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5046 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5047 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5048 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5049 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5050 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5051
5052 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5053 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5054 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5055 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5056 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5057
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005058 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5059 consistent hashing mechanism.
5060
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005061 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5062
5063
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005064hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005065 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 yes | no | yes | yes
5068 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005069 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5070 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005071
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005072 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5073 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5074 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5075 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5076 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5077 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5078 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5079 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5080 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5081 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005082
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005083 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5084 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5085 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5086 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5087 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5088 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5089 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5090 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5091 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5092 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5093 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5094 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5095 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005096 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5097 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005098
5099 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5100
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005101 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005102 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5103 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5104 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005105 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5106 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5107 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005108
5109 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5110 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005111 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5112 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5113 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5114 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5115
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005116 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005117 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5118 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5119 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5120 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5121 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5122 parameter.
5123
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005124 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5125 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5126 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5127 used on strings.
5128
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005129 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5130
5131 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5132 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5133 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5134 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5135 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5136 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5137 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5138 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5139 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5140 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5141 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5142 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005143
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005144 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5145 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5146 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005147
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005148 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005149
5150
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005151http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5152 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5153 ones).
5154
5155 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5156 no | yes | yes | yes
5157
5158 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5159 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5160 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5161 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5162 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5163 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5164
5165 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5166 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5167 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5168
5169 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5170 below.
5171
5172 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5173 instance.
5174
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005175 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5176 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5177 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5178
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005179 Example:
5180 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5181 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5182 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5183
5184http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185
5186 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5187 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5188 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5189 example, or to pass some internal information.
5190 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5191 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5192 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5193
5194http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5195
5196 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5197 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5198
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005199http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005200
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005201 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5202 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5203 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5204 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5205 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005206
5207http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5209
5210 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5211
5212 Example:
5213 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5214
5215 # applied to:
5216 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5217
5218 # outputs:
5219 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5220
5221 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5222
5223http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5224 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5225
5226 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5227
5228 Example:
5229 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5230
5231 # applied to:
5232 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5233
5234 # outputs:
5235 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5236
5237http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238
5239 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5240 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5241 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5242
5243http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5244 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5245
5246 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5247 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5248 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5249 fallback.
5250
5251 Example:
5252 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5253 http-response set-status 431
5254 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5255 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5256
5257http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5258
5259 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5260 inline.
5261
5262 Arguments:
5263 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5264 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5267 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5268 (request and response)
5269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5270 processing
5271 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5272 processing
5273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5274 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5275 and '_'.
5276
5277 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5278 followed by some converters.
5279
5280 Example:
5281 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5282
5283http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5284
5285 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5286 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5287 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5288 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5289 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005290 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005291 processing.
5292
5293 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5294 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005295 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005296 rules evaluation.
5297
5298http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5299
5300 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5301 details about <var-name>.
5302
5303 Example:
5304 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5305
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005306
5307http-check comment <string>
5308 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5309 it fails.
5310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5311 yes | no | yes | yes
5312
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005313 Arguments :
5314 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5315 rule fails.
5316
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005317 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5318 user-friendly error reporting.
5319
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005321 "http-check expect".
5322
5323
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005324http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5325 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005326 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005327 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
5330
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005331 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005332 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5333
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005334 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005335 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005336
5337 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5338 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5339 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5340 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5341
5342 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5343
5344 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5345
5346 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5347
5348 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5349
5350 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5351
5352 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5353 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5354 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5355 is used.
5356
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005357 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5358 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5359 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5360 haproxy -vv.
5361
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005362 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5363
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005364 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5365 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5366 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5367 different ports or with different servers.
5368
5369 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5370 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5371 the port with a "http-check connect".
5372
5373 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5374 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5375 do.
5376
5377 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5378 unset-var or comment rules.
5379
5380 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005381 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5382 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5383 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5384 option httpchk
5385
5386 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005387 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005388 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005389 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005390 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005391 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392
5393 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5394
5395 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005396
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005398http-check disable-on-404
5399 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005401 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005402 Arguments : none
5403
5404 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5405 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5406 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5407 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5408 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5409 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5410 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5411 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005412 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5413 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005414 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5415 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5416 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005417
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005418 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005419
5420
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005421http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005422 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5423 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5424 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005425 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005427 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005428
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005429 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005430 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5431
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005432 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5433 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5434 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5435 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5436 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5437 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5438 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5439 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5440 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5441 result is always conclusive.
5442
5443 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5444 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5445 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005446 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5447 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005448 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5449 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005450 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5451 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5452 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453
5454 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5455 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005456 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5457 supported :
5458 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5459 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005460 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5461 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5462 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5463 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5464 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465
5466 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5467 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005468 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5469 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5470 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5471 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005472 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5473
5474 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5475 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5476 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5477 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5478
5479 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5480 informational message reported in logs if an error
5481 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5482 log-format string.
5483
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005484 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005485 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5486 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005487 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5488 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5489 details on the supported keywords.
5490
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005491 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5492 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5493 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5494 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005495
5496 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5497 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5498 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5499 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5500 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5501
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005502 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5503 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5504 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5505 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5506 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5507 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5508 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005509
5510 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005511 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005512 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5513 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5514 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5515 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5516
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005517 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5518 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005519 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5520 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5521 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5522 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5523 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5524 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5525 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5526 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005527 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5528 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5529 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5530 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5531 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5532 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5533 insensitive on the header names.
5534
5535 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5536 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5537 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5538 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5539 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5540 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005541
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005542 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005543 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005544 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5545 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5546 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5547 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5548 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005549 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550 trace).
5551
5552 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005553 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005554 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5555 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5556 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5557 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5558 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005559 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005561 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5562 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5563 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5564 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5565 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5566 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5567
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005568 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005569 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005570 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5571 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5572 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5573 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5574 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5575 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5576
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005577 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5578 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5579 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5580 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5581 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005582
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005583 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5584 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5585
5586 Examples :
5587 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005588 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005589
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005590 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5591 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5592
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005593 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005594 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005595
5596 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005597 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005598
5599 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005600 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005601
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005602 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005603 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005604
5605
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005606http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005607 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5608 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005609 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5610 health checks.
5611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5612 yes | no | yes | yes
5613 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005614 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5615
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005616 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5617 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5618 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5619 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5620 to invent non-standard ones.
5621
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005622 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5623 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5624 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5625 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5626
5627 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5628 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5629 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5630 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005631
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005632 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005633 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005634 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005635 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5636 to add it.
5637
5638 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5639 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5640 to the log-format rules.
5641
5642 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5643 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5644 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005645
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005646 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5647 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5648 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5649 request.
5650
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005651 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5652 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5653 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005654 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5655 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5656 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5657 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005658 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005659
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005660 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005661 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5662 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005663
5664 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5665 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5666 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5667 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5668 configured request authority.
5669
5670 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5671 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005673 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005674
5675
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005676http-check send-state
5677 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 yes | no | yes | yes
5680 Arguments : none
5681
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005682 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005683 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005684 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5685 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5686 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005687
5688 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5689 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5690 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5691 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5692 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005693 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5694 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5695 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5696
5697 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5698 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5699 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5700
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005701 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5702 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5703 checked in multiple backends.
5704
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005705 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005706 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5707
5708 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5709 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5710 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5711 one fails.
5712
5713 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5714 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5715 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5716
5717 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5718 server's queue.
5719
5720 Example of a header received by the application server :
5721 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5722 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5723
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005724 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5725 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005726
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005727
5728http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005729 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 yes | no | yes | yes
5732
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005733 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005734 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5735 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5736 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5737 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5738 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5739 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5740 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5741 and '-'.
5742
5743 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5744
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005745 Examples :
5746 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747
5748
5749http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005750 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5752 yes | no | yes | yes
5753
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005754 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5756 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5757 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5758 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5759 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5760 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5761 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5762 and '-'.
5763
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005764 Examples :
5765 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005767
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005768http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5769 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5770 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5771 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5772 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | yes | yes | yes
5775 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005776 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005777 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005778 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005779 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005780
5781 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5782 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5783 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5784 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5785
5786 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5787 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5788 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5789 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5790
5791 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5792 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5793 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5794 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5795 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5796 chroot is performed.
5797
5798 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5799 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5800 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5801 considered.
5802
5803 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5804 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5805 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5806 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5807 considered as a raw string.
5808
5809 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5810 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5811 "content-type".
5812
5813 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5814 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5815 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5816 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5817 evaluated as a log-format string.
5818
5819 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5820 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5821 argument to "content-type".
5822
5823 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5824 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5825 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5826 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5827
5828 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5829 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5830 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5831 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5832 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5833 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5834 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5835 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5836
5837 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5838 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5839 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5840
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005841 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5842 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5843 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5844 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5845 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5846
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005847 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5848 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5849
5850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005851http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005852 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5853
5854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 no | yes | yes | yes
5856
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005857 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5858 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5859 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5860 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5861 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005863 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5864 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005866 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868 Example:
5869 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5870 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5871 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005873 http-request allow if nagios
5874 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5875 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5876 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878 Example:
5879 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5880 acl add path /addacl
5881 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005883 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005885 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5886 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005887
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005888 Example:
5889 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5890 acl setmap path /setmap
5891 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5896 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5899 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5904 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5905 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5906 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5907 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5908 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5909 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5910 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005912http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5915 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5916 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5917 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5918 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5919 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5920 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5921 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005923http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5926 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005927
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005929http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005931 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5932 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5933 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5934 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5935 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005937 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5938 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5939 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5940 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5941 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5942 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5943 instead.
5944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945 Example:
5946 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5947 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005949http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005950
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005951 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5954 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005956 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5957 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5958 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5959 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5960 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5961 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5962 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5963 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5964 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005966 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5967 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5968 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005969 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5970
5971 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5972 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5973 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5974 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005975
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005976http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005978 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5979 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5980 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5981 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5982 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5983 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005984
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005985http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005986
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005987 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5988 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5989 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5990 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5991 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005995 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5996 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5997 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5998 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5999 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6000 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006001
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006002http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6003http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6004 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6005 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6006 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6007 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006008
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006009 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6010 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6011 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006012 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006013 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6014 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6015 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006017 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006018
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006019http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6021 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6022 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6023
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006024http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6025
6026 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6027 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6028 pointed by <resolvers>.
6029 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6030 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6031 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6032 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6033 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6034 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6035 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6036 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6037 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6038 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6039 to 0.0.0.0.
6040
6041 Example:
6042 resolvers mydns
6043 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6044 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6045 timeout retry 1s
6046 hold valid 10s
6047 hold nx 3s
6048 hold other 3s
6049 hold obsolete 0s
6050 accepted_payload_size 8192
6051
6052 frontend fe
6053 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6054 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6055 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6056
6057 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6058 # which mean DNS resolution error
6059 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6060
6061 default_backend be
6062
6063 backend b_503
6064 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6065 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6066 # 503 error page to end users
6067
6068 backend be
6069 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6070 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6071 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6072 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6073 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6074
6075 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6076 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6077
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006078http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6079
6080 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6081 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6082 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6083 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006084 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6085 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006086
6087 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6088
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006089http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006090http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006091http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006092http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006093http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006094http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006095http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006096http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6097http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006098
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006099 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6100
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006101 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006102 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6103 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6104 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6105 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006106
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006107 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6108 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6109 the supported backend.
6110
6111 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6112 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6113 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6114 number of segments in the path.
6115
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006116 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6117 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6118 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6119 when improperly combined.
6120
6121 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6122 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6123 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6124 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6125 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6126
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006127 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006128
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006129 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6130
6131 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6132 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6133
6134 Example:
6135 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6136
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006137 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6138
6139 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6140 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6141
6142 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6143 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6144
6145 Example:
6146 - /#foo -> /
6147
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006148 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6149 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006150
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006151 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6152 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6153
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006154 Example:
6155 - /. -> /
6156 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6157 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6158 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006159
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006160 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6161 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6162
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006163 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006164 their preceding segment.
6165
6166 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6167 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6168
6169 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6170 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006171
6172 Example:
6173 - /foo/../ -> /
6174 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6175 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6176 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006177 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006178 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006179 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006180
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006181 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6182 removed as well:
6183
6184 Example:
6185 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6186 - /bar/../../ -> /
6187
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006188 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6189 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006190
6191 Example:
6192 - // -> /
6193 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6194
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006195 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6196 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6197
6198 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6199 ".", "_", and "~".
6200
6201 Example:
6202 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6203 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6204 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6205 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6206
6207 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6208 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6209
6210 Example:
6211 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6212 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6213
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006214 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006215 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006216
6217 Example:
6218 - /%6f -> /%6F
6219 - /%zz -> /%zz
6220
6221 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6222 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6223
6224 Example:
6225 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6226
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006227 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006228 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6229 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6230
6231 Example:
6232 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6233 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6234 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006236http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006238 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6239 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6240 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6241 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6242 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006244http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006246 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6247 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6248 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6249 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006251http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6252 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006253
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006254 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006255 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6256 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6257 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6258 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6259 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006260
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006261 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6262 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6263 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6264 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6265 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006266
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006267 Example:
6268 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6269
6270 # applied to:
6271 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6272
6273 # outputs:
6274 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6275
6276 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006277
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006278 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6279
6280 # applied to:
6281 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006282
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006283 # outputs:
6284 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006285
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006286http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6287 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6288
6289 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6290 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006291 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6292 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6293 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006294
6295 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6296 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6297 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6298
6299 Example:
6300 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6301 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6302
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006303 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6304 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6305 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6306 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6307
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006308http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6309 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6310
6311 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6312 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6313 query-string are replaced.
6314
6315 Example:
6316 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6317 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6318
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006319http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6320 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6321
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006322 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6323 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6324 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6325 against.
6326
6327 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6328 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6329 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006330
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006331 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6332 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6333 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6334 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6335 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6336 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6337 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6338 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6339 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006340 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6341 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006342
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006343 Example:
6344 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6345 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006346
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006347 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6348 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006350http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6351 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006352
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006353 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6354 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6355 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6356 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006357
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006358 Example:
6359 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006360
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006361 # applied to:
6362 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006363
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006364 # outputs:
6365 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006366
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006367http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6368 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6369 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006370 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006371 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6372
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006373 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006374 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6375 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006376 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006377 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006378 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006379 are followed to create the response :
6380
6381 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6382 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6383 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6384 ignored.
6385
6386 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6387 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006388 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006389 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6390 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006391
6392 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6393 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6394 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006395 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006396 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006397
6398 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6399 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6400 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006401 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006402 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006403 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006404
6405 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6406 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6407 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6408 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6409 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6410 as a raw content.
6411
6412 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6413 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6414 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6415 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6416 considered as a raw string.
6417
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006418 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006419 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6420 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6421 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6422
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006423 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6424 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006425 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006426
6427 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6428
6429 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006430 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006431 if { path /ping }
6432
6433 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6434 if { path /favicon.ico }
6435
6436 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6437 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6438 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6439
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006440http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6441
6442 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6443 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6444 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6445 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6446 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6447 at this index.
6448 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6449 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6450
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006451http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6452http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006454 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6455 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6456 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006457
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006458http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6459 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6460 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6461 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6462 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6463 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6464 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6465 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6466 at this index.
6467 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6468 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6469
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006470http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006472
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006473 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6474 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6475 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6476 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006480 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6481 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6482 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6483 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6484 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486 Arguments:
6487 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6488 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006490 Example:
6491 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6492 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006494 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6495 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006497http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006499 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6500 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6501 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006503 Arguments:
6504 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6505 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006507 Example:
6508 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6509 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006511 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6512 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6513 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006515http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6518 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6519 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6520 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6521 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006523 Example:
6524 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6525 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6526 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6527 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6528 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006536 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6537 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6538 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6539 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6540 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6543 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006545 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6546 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6547 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6548 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6549 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6550 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6551 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6552 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6553 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006555http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006556
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006557 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6558 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6559 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6560 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6561 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6562 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6563 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006564 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6565 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006567http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6570 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6571 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006573http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6576 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6577 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6578 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6579 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6580 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6581 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6582 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006586 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6587 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6588 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6589 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6590 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6591 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006593 Example :
6594 # prepend the host name before the path
6595 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006596
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006597http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6598
6599 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6600 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6601 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006605 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6606 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6607 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6608 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6609 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6614 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6615 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6616 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6617 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6618 values have higher priority.
6619 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6620 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6621 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6622 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6623 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006627 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6628 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6629 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6630 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6631 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6632 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6633 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006636
6637 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6639 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006641http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6642 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6643 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6644 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006645 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6646 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647
6648 Arguments :
6649 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6650 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006651
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006652 See also "option forwardfor".
6653
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006654 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006655 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6656 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6657
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006658 # After the masking this will track connections
6659 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6660 http-request track-sc0 src
6661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6663 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6664
6665http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6666
6667 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6668 expression.
6669
6670 Arguments:
6671 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6672 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006673
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006674 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6676 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6677
6678 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6679 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6680 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6681
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006682http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006683 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6684
6685 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6686 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6687 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6688 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6689 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6690
6691 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6692 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6693 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6694 results.
6695
6696 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006697 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6698 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6701
6702 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6703 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6704 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6705 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6706 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6707 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6708 information from the request.
6709
6710 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6711
6712http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6713
6714 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6715 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6716 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6717 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6718 path and the query string.
6719 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6720
6721http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6722
6723 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6724 inline.
6725
6726 Arguments:
6727 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6728 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6729 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6730 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6731 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6732 (request and response)
6733 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6734 processing
6735 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6736 processing
6737 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6738 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6739 and '_'.
6740
6741 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6742 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006743
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006744 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6748 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6751 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6752 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6753 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6754 agent name must be used.
6755
6756 Arguments:
6757 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6758
6759 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6760 configuration.
6761
6762http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6763
6764 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6765 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6766 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6767 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6768 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6769 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6770 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6771 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6772 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6773 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6774 action.
6775 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6776 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6777 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6778 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6779 you fully understand how it works.
6780
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006781http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6782
6783 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6784 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6785 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6786 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6787 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006788 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006789 processing.
6790
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006791 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006792 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6793 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6794 rules evaluation.
6795
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006796http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6797http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6798 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6799 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6800 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6801 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006802
6803 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6804 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6805 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006806 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6807 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6808 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6809 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6810 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6811 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006812 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006813 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6814 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6815 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006816 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006817 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6818 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6819 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6820 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6821 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006822
6823http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6826
6827 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6828 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6829 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6830 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006831 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006832 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6833 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6834 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6835 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6836 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6837 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6838 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6839
6840 Arguments :
6841 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6842 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6843 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6844 select which table entry to update the counters.
6845
6846 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6847 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6848 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6849 that table until the session ends.
6850
6851 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6852 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6853 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6854 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6855 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6856 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6857 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6858 useful information.
6859
6860 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6861 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6862 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6863 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6864 checks that make use of it.
6865
6866http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6867
6868 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006869
6870 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006871 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006872
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006873http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6874
6875 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6876 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6877 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6878 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6879 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6880 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6881
6882 Arguments :
6883 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6884
6885 Example:
6886 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6887
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006888http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6889 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6890
6891 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6892 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6893 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6894 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6895 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6896 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6897 http-buffer-request".
6898
6899 Arguments :
6900
6901 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6902 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6903
6904 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006905 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006906 bytes.
6907
6908 Example:
6909 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6910
6911 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006913http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006915 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6916 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6917 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006918
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006920http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006921 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6922
6923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 no | yes | yes | yes
6925
6926 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6927 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6928 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6929 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6930 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6931 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006933 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6934 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006936 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006938 Example:
6939 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006941 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006943 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6944 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006946 Example:
6947 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006949 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006951 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6952 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006954 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6955 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006957http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006959 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6960 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6961 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6962 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6963 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6964 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6965 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6966 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6971 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6972 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6973 example, or to pass some internal information.
6974 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6975 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6976 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6981 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006982
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006983http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006984
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006985 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006987http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006989 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6990 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6991 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6992 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6993 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6994 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6995 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006997 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6998 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6999 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7000 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7001 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007002
7003 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7004 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7005 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7006 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007008http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007010 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7011 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7012 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7013 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7014 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7015 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007016
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007017http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007018
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007019 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7020 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7021 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7022 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7023 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007025http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007027 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7028 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7029 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7030 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7031 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7032 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007033
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007034http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7035http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7036 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7037 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7038 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7039 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007040
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007041 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7042 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7043 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007044 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007045 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7046 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7047 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007048 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007049 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007053 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7054 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7055 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7056 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7057 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7058 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007060http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7061 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007062
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007063 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7064 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007066 Example:
7067 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069 # applied to:
7070 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072 # outputs:
7073 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7078 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007079
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007080 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007081 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083 Example:
7084 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007086 # applied to:
7087 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089 # outputs:
7090 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007091
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007092http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7093 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7094 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007095 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007096 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7097
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007098 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007099 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7100 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007101 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007102 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007103 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007104 are followed to create the response :
7105
7106 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7107 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7108 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7109 ignored.
7110
7111 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7112 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007113 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007114 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7115 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007116
7117 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7118 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7119 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007120 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007121 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007122
7123 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7124 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7125 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007126 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007127 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007128 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007129
7130 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7131 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7132 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7133 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7134 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7135 as a raw content.
7136
7137 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7138 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7139 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7140 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7141 considered as a raw string.
7142
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007143 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7144 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7145 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7146 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7147
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007148 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7149 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007150 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007151
7152 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7153
7154 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007155 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007156 if { status eq 404 }
7157
7158 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7159 string "This is the end !" \
7160 if { status eq 500 }
7161
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007162http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7163
7164 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7165 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7166 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7167 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7168 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7169 at this index.
7170 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7171 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7174http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7177 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7178 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007179
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007180http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7181 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7182
7183 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7184 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7185 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7186 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7187 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7188 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7189 at this index.
7190 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7191 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7192
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007193http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007195
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007196 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7197 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7198 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7199 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007201http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007203 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7204 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7205 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7206 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7207 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007209 Arguments:
7210 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007212 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7213 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007215http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007217 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7218 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7219 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007221http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7222
7223 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7224 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7225 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7226 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7227 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7228
7229http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7230
7231 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7232 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7233 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7234 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7235 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7236 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7237 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7238 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7239 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7240
7241http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7242
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007243 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7244 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7245 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7246 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7247 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7248 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7249 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007250 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7251 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007252
7253http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7254
7255 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7256 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7257 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7258 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7259 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7260 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7261 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7262 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7263
7264http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7265 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7266
7267 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7268 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7269 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7270 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007271
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007272 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007273 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7274 http-response set-status 431
7275 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7276 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007277
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007278http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007280 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7281 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7282 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7283 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7284 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7285 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7286 based on some information from the request.
7287
7288 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7289
7290http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7291
7292 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7293 inline.
7294
7295 Arguments:
7296 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7297 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7298 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7299 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7300 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7301 (request and response)
7302 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7303 processing
7304 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7305 processing
7306 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7307 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7308 and '_'.
7309
7310 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7311 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007312
7313 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007314 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007316http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007317
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007318 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7319 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7320 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7321 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7322 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7323 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7324 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7325 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7326 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7327 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7328 action.
7329 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7330 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7331 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7332 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7333 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007334
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007335http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7336
7337 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7338 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7339 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7340 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7341 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007342 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007343 processing.
7344
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007345 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007346 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007347 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007348 rules evaluation.
7349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7351http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7352http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007354 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7355 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7356 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7357 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7358 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007359 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360
7361http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7362
7363 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7364 about <var-name>.
7365
7366 Example:
7367 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7368
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007369http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7371
7372 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7373 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7374 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7375 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7376 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7377 buffer is full.
7378
7379 Arguments :
7380
7381 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7382 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7383
7384 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007385 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007386 bytes.
7387
7388 Example:
7389 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007390
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007391http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7392 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7393
7394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 yes | no | yes | yes
7396
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007397 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007398 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7399 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7400 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007401
7402 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7403
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007404 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7405 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7406 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7407 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7408 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7409 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7410 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007411 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007412 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7413 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007414
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007415 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7416 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7417 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7418 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7419 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7420 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7421 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007422 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7423 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7424 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7425 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7426 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7427 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007428
7429 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7430 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7431 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7432 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7433 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7434 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7435 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7436 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007437 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007438 downsides of rare connection failures.
7439
7440 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7441 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7442 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7443 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7444 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7445 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007446 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007447 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7448 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7449 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7450 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7451 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7452
7453 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007454 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7455 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7456 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7457 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007458
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007459 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7460 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007461
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007462 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007463
7464 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7465 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7466 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7467
7468 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7469
7470
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007471http-send-name-header [<header>]
7472 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007473 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7474 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007475 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007476 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7477
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007478 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7479 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7480 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7481 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7482 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7483 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7484 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7485 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7486 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7487 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7488 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7489 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7490 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7491 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7492 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7493 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007494
7495 See also : "server"
7496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007497id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007498 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7500 no | yes | yes | yes
7501 Arguments : none
7502
7503 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7504 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7505 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007506
7507
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007508ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7509 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007511 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007512
7513 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7514 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7515 and running).
7516
7517 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7518 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7519 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007520 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007521 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7522
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007523 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7524 "unless" condition is met.
7525
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007526 Example:
7527 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7528 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7529 ignore-persist if url_static
7530
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007531 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7532
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007533load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7534 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7535 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 yes | no | yes | yes
7537
7538 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7539 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7540 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007541 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007542 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007543 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7544 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7545 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7546
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007547 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007548 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007549 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007550
7551 Arguments:
7552 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7553 named "server-state-file".
7554
7555 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7556 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7557 name is used as a file name.
7558
7559 none don't load any stat for this backend
7560
7561 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007562 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7563 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7564 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007565 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007566 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007567
7568 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7569 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7570
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007571 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007572
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007573 global
7574 stats socket /tmp/socket
7575 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007576
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007577 defaults
7578 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007579
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007580 backend bk
7581 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7582 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007583
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007584
7585 Then one can run :
7586
7587 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7588
7589 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7590
7591 1
7592 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7593 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7594 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7595
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007596 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007597
7598 global
7599 stats socket /tmp/socket
7600 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7601
7602 defaults
7603 load-server-state-from-file local
7604
7605 backend bk
7606 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7607 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7608
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007609
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007610 Then one can run :
7611
7612 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7613
7614 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7615
7616 1
7617 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7618 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7619 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7620
7621 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7622 "show servers state"
7623
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007624
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007625log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007626log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007627 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007628no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007629 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7631 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007632
7633 Prefix :
7634 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7635 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7636 prefix does not allow arguments.
7637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007638 Arguments :
7639 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7640 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7641 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7642 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7643 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7644 parameter.
7645
7646 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7647 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7648
7649 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7650 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7651 standard syslog port).
7652
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007653 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7654 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7655 standard syslog port).
7656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007657 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7658 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7659 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007660 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007661
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007662 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7663 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7664 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7665 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7666 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7667 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7668 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7669 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7670 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7671 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7672 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7673 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007674 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007675 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7676 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7677 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007678 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7679 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007680
7681 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7682 and "fd@2", see above.
7683
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007684 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7685 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7686 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7687 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7688 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7689 having the logs instantly available.
7690
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007691 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7692 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7693 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7694
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007695 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7696 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007697
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007698 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7699 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7700 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7701 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7702 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7703 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7704 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7705 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7706 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7707 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007708 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007709
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007710 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7711 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7712 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7713 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7714 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7715
7716 <sample_size>
7717 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7718 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7719 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7720 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7721 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7722
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007723 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7724 one of the following :
7725
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007726 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7727 field is stripped. This is the default.
7728 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7729 rfc3164.
7730
7731 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007732 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7733
7734 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7735 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7736
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007737 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7738 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7739 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7740 designed to be used with a local log server.
7741
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007742 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7743 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7744 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7745 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7746 systemd logger consumes.
7747
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007748 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7749 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7750 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7751 used with a local log server.
7752
7753 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7754 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7755 designed to be used with a local log server.
7756
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007757 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7758 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7759 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7760 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7761
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007762 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7763
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007764 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7765 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7766 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7767
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007768 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7769 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7770 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7771 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007772
7773 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7774 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7775 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007776 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7777 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7778 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7779 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7780 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007781
7782 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7783
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007784 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7785 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7786 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007787
7788 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7789 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7790 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7791 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7792
7793 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7794 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007795
7796 Example :
7797 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007798 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7799 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7800 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007801 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007802 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7803 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007804 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007805
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007806
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007807log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007808 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7810 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007811
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007812 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7813 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7814 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7815 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7816 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007817
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007818 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7819 "option httplog" directives.
7820
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007821log-format-sd <string>
7822 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | yes | yes | no
7825
7826 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7827 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7828 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7829 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7830 which covers the log format string in depth.
7831
7832 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7833 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7834
7835 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7836 log format to "rfc5424".
7837
7838 Example :
7839 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7840
7841
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007842log-tag <string>
7843 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 yes | yes | yes | yes
7846
7847 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7848 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007849 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007850 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7851 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7852 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7853 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7854 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7855 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007856
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007857max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7858 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7860 yes | no | yes | yes
7861
7862 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7863 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7864 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7865 servers.
7866
7867 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007868 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007869 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7870 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7871 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007872 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007873 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7874 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7875 picking a different server.
7876
7877 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7878 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7879 even if they have to be queued.
7880
7881 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7882 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7883
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007884max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7885 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7886 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7887 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007888
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007889maxconn <conns>
7890 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | yes | yes | no
7893 Arguments :
7894 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7895 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7896 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7897 closes.
7898
7899 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007900 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007901 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7902 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007903 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7904 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7905 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7906 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007907
7908 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7909 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7910 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7911
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007912 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7913 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007914
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007915 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7916
7917
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007918mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007919 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7921 yes | yes | yes | yes
7922 Arguments :
7923 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7924 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7925 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7926 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7927
7928 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7929 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7930 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7931 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7932 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7933
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007934 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7935 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7936 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007937
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007938 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007939 defaults http_instances
7940 mode http
7941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007943monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007944 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007947 Arguments :
7948 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7949 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007950 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007951 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7952 backend and its backup.
7953
7954 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7955 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7956 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7957 servers in a list of backends.
7958
7959 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7960 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7961 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007962 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007963 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7964 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007965 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007966 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7967 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007968
7969 Example:
7970 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007971 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007972 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7973 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7974 monitor-uri /site_alive
7975 monitor fail if site_dead
7976
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007977 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007978
7979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007980monitor-uri <uri>
7981 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7983 yes | yes | yes | no
7984 Arguments :
7985 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7986 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7987
7988 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7989 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7990 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7991 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7992 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7993 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7994 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7995 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7996
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007997 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007998 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7999 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8000 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8001 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8002 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8003 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008004
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008005 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8006 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8007 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8008 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8009
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008010 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008011 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008012 frontend www
8013 mode http
8014 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8015
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008016 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008018
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008019option abortonclose
8020no option abortonclose
8021 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8023 yes | no | yes | yes
8024 Arguments : none
8025
8026 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8027 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8028 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8029 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008030 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008031 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8032 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8033 encountered while delivering the response.
8034
8035 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8036 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8037 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8038 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8039 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8040 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008041 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008042 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008043 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008044 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8045 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8046 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008048 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8049 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008050 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8051 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8052 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8053 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8054 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8055 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008056 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008057
8058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8060
8061 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8062
8063
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008064option accept-invalid-http-request
8065no option accept-invalid-http-request
8066 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8068 yes | yes | yes | no
8069 Arguments : none
8070
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008071 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008072 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008073 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008074 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8075 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8076 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8077 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8078 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008079 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8080 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8081 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8082 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008083 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008084 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008085 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8086 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8087 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008088
8089 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8090 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8091 been confirmed.
8092
8093 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8094 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008095 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8096 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008097 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8098
8099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8101
8102 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8103 stats socket.
8104
8105
8106option accept-invalid-http-response
8107no option accept-invalid-http-response
8108 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 yes | no | yes | yes
8111 Arguments : none
8112
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008113 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008114 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008115 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008116 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8117 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8118 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8119 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8120 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008121 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8122 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8123 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008124
8125 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8126 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8127 been confirmed.
8128
8129 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8130 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8131 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8132 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8133
8134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8136
8137 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8138 stats socket.
8139
8140
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008141option allbackups
8142no option allbackups
8143 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8145 yes | no | yes | yes
8146 Arguments : none
8147
8148 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8149 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8150 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8151 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8152 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8153 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8154 order between the backup servers anymore.
8155
8156 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8157 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8158
8159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8161
8162
8163option checkcache
8164no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008165 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | no | yes | yes
8168 Arguments : none
8169
8170 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8171 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008172 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8174 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008175 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008176
8177 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008178 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008179 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008180 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8181 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008182 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008183 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008184 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8185 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008186 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008187 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8188 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008189 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008190 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8191 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8192 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8193 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8194 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8195 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8196 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8197 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8198 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8199
8200 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008201 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8202 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8203 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8204 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008205
8206 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8207 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008208 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008209 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210
8211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8213
8214
8215option clitcpka
8216no option clitcpka
8217 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 yes | yes | yes | no
8220 Arguments : none
8221
8222 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8223 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008224 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008225 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8226
8227 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8228 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8229 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8230 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8231
8232 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8233 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8234 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8235 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8236 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8237
8238 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8239
8240 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8241 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8242 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8243
8244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8246
8247 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8248
8249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008250option contstats
8251 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8253 yes | yes | yes | no
8254 Arguments : none
8255
8256 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8257 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8258 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008259 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008260 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8261 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8262 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8263 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8264 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008265
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008266option disable-h2-upgrade
8267no option disable-h2-upgrade
8268 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8269 connection.
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 yes | yes | yes | no
8272 Arguments : none
8273
8274 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8275 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8276 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8277 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008278 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8279 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8280 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8281 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8282 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8283 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008284
8285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008287
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008288option dontlog-normal
8289no option dontlog-normal
8290 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8292 yes | yes | yes | no
8293 Arguments : none
8294
8295 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8296 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8297 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8298 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8299 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8300 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8301 logged.
8302
8303 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8304 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8305 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008307 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008308 logging.
8309
8310
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008311option dontlognull
8312no option dontlognull
8313 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 yes | yes | yes | no
8316 Arguments : none
8317
8318 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8319 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8320 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8321 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8322 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8323 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008324 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8325 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8326 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008327
8328 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008329 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008330 would not be logged.
8331
8332 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8333 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8334
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008335 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008336 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008338
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008339option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008340 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | yes | yes | yes
8343 Arguments :
8344 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8345 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008346 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008347 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008348
8349 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8350 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8351 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8352 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8353 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8354 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8355 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008356 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8357 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8358 possible that the client has already brought one.
8359
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008360 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008361 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008362 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008363 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008364 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008365 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008366
8367 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8368 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8369 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8370 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8371 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8372 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008373 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008374
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008375 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8376 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008377 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008378 are under the control of the end-user.
8379
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008380 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008381 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8382 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008383 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8384 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8385 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008386
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008387 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008388 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8389 frontend www
8390 mode http
8391 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8392
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008393 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8394 backend www
8395 mode http
8396 option forwardfor header X-Client
8397
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008398 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008399 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008400
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008401
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008402option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8403no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8404 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | yes | yes | no
8407 Arguments : none
8408
8409 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8410 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8411 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8412 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8413 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8414 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8415 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8416
8417 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8418 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8419 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8420 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8421 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8422 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8423 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8424 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8425 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8426 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8427
8428 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8429
8430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8432
8433 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8434 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8435
8436
8437option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8438no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8439 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8441 yes | no | yes | yes
8442 Arguments : none
8443
8444 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8445 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8446 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8447 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8448 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8449 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8450 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8451
8452 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8453 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8454 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8455 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8456 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8457 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8458 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8459 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8460 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8461 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8462
8463 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8464
8465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8467
8468 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8469 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8470
8471
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008472option http-buffer-request
8473no option http-buffer-request
8474 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 yes | yes | yes | yes
8477 Arguments : none
8478
8479 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8480 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8481 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8482 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8483 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8484 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008485 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8486 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8487 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8488 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008489
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008490 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8491 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008492
8493
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008494option http-ignore-probes
8495no option http-ignore-probes
8496 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8498 yes | yes | yes | no
8499 Arguments : none
8500
8501 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8502 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8503 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8504 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8505 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8506 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8507 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8508 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8509 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008510 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8511 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008512 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8513
8514 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8515 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8516 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8517 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8518 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8519 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8520 are often the only way to detect them.
8521
8522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8524
8525 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8526
8527
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008528option http-keep-alive
8529no option http-keep-alive
8530 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8532 yes | yes | yes | yes
8533 Arguments : none
8534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008535 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8536 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008537 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8538 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008539 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8540 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8541 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008542
8543 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8544 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008545 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8546 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8547 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8548 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8549 situations where this option may be useful :
8550
8551 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008552 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008553
8554 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8555 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8556
8557 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8558 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8559 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8560 request.
8561
8562 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8563 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008564 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8565 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8566 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008567
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008568 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8569 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8570 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8571 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8572 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8573 not set.
8574
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008575 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8576 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8577 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008578
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008579 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008580 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008581 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008582
8583
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008584option http-no-delay
8585no option http-no-delay
8586 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8588 yes | yes | yes | yes
8589 Arguments : none
8590
8591 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8592 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8593 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8594 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8595 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8596 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8597 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008598 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008599 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8600 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8601 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8602 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8603 affected.
8604
8605 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8606 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8607 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8608 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8609 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8610 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8611 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8612 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8613 latency environments.
8614
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008615 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8616
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008617
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008618option http-pretend-keepalive
8619no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008620 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008623 Arguments : none
8624
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008625 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008626 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8627 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8628 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008629 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008630 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8631 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8632 consider the response complete.
8633
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008634 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008635 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008636 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008637 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008638 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008639 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8640
8641 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8642 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8643 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8644 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008645 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8646 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008647 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8648
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008649 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8650 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8651 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8652 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8653 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8654 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008655
8656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8658
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008659 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008660 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008661
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008662
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008663option http-server-close
8664no option http-server-close
8665 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8667 yes | yes | yes | yes
8668 Arguments : none
8669
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008670 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8671 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8672 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8673 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008674 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8675 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8676 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8677 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8678 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8679 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8680 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8681 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8682 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8683 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8684 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008685
8686 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8687 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8688 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8689 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008690 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8691 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008692
8693 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8694 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008695 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8696 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8697 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008698
8699 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8700 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8701
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008702 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8703 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008704
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008705option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008706no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008707 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8709 yes | yes | yes | no
8710 Arguments : none
8711
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008712 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008713 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8714 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8715 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8716 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8717 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008718 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008719
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008720 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008721 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008722 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8723 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8724 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008725
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008726 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8727 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8728 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8729 front of an existing proxy.
8730
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008731 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8732
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008733 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008734
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008735option httpchk
8736option httpchk <uri>
8737option httpchk <method> <uri>
8738option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008739 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8741 yes | no | yes | yes
8742 Arguments :
8743 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8744 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8745 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8746 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8747 ones.
8748
8749 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8750 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8751 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8752
8753 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8754 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8755 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008756 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008757
8758 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8759 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8760 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8761 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8762 the lack of any response.
8763
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008764 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8765 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8766 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8767 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8768
8769 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8770 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8771 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008772
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008773 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8774 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008775 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008776 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008777 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008778
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008779 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8780 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8781 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8782 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8783
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008784 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008785 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8786 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8787 backend https_relay
8788 mode tcp
8789 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8790 http-check send hdr Host www
8791 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008792
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008793 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8794 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8795 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008796
8797
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008798option httpclose
8799no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008800 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8802 yes | yes | yes | yes
8803 Arguments : none
8804
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008805 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8806 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8807 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8808 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008809 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008810
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008811 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8812 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008813 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008814 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8815 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008816
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008817 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8818 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8819 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008820
8821 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8822 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008823 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8824 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8825 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008826
8827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8829
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008830 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008831
8832
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008833option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008834 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008836 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008837 Arguments :
8838 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8839 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8840 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008841 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008842 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008843
8844 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8845 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8846 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8847 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8848 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8849 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8850 ports.
8851
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008852 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8853 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008854
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008855 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008857 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008858
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008859
8860option http_proxy
8861no option http_proxy
8862 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8864 yes | yes | yes | yes
8865 Arguments : none
8866
8867 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8868 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8869 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8870 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8871 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8872
8873 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8874 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008875 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8876 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008877
8878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8880
8881 Example :
8882 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8883 backend direct_forward
8884 option httpclose
8885 option http_proxy
8886
8887 See also : "option httpclose"
8888
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008889
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008890option independent-streams
8891no option independent-streams
8892 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8894 yes | yes | yes | yes
8895 Arguments : none
8896
8897 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8898 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8899 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8900 receive data or not.
8901
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008902 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008903 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8904 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8905 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8906 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8907 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8908 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8909 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8910 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8911 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8912 socket buffers.
8913
8914 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8915 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8916 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8917 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8918 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8919
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008920 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008921
8922
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008923option ldap-check
8924 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8926 yes | no | yes | yes
8927 Arguments : none
8928
8929 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8930 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8931 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8932 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8933
8934 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8935 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8936
8937 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8938 configure it.
8939
8940 Example :
8941 option ldap-check
8942
8943 See also : "option httpchk"
8944
8945
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008946option external-check
8947 Use external processes for server health checks
8948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8949 yes | no | yes | yes
8950
8951 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8952 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8953 command".
8954
8955 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8956
8957 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8958
8959
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008960option log-health-checks
8961no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008962 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 yes | no | yes | yes
8965 Arguments : none
8966
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008967 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8968 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8969 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008970
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008971 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8972 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8973 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8974 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8975 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8976
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008977 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008978 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008979
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008980 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8981 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8982 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008983
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008984
8985option log-separate-errors
8986no option log-separate-errors
8987 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 yes | yes | yes | no
8990 Arguments : none
8991
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008992 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008993 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8994 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8995 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8996 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8997 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8998 provides very important information.
8999
9000 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9001 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9002 error logs.
9003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009004 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009005 logging.
9006
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009007
9008option logasap
9009no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009010 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9012 yes | yes | yes | no
9013 Arguments : none
9014
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009015 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9016 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9017 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9018 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9019
9020 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9021 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9022 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9023 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9024 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009025 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009026 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9027 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9028 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9029 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009030 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009031
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009032 Examples :
9033 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9034 mode http
9035 option httplog
9036 option logasap
9037 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9038
9039 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9040 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9041 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9042 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009044 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009045 logging.
9046
9047
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009048option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009049 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9051 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009052 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009053 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9054 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009055 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9056 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009057
9058 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9059 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009060 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009061 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009062 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9063 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9064 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009065
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009066 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9067 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9068 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009069
9070 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009071 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009072 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9073 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9074 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9075 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9076 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9077 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9078 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9079
9080 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9081 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009082
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009083 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009084
9085 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9086 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9087 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9088 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009089 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009090 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009091
9092 See also: "option httpchk"
9093
9094
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009095option nolinger
9096no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009097 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009100 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009101
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009102 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009103 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9104 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9105 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9106 connections.
9107
9108 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9109 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009110 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9111 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9112 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9113 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9114 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9115 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9116 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9117 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9118 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9119 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9120 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9121 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9122 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009123
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009124 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9125 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9126 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9127 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9128 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009129
9130 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9131 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009132 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009133 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009134 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009135
9136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9138
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009139 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9140 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009141
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009142option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9143 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9145 yes | yes | yes | yes
9146 Arguments :
9147 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9148 matching <network>
9149 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9150 header name.
9151
9152 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9153 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9154 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9155 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9156 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9157 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9158 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9159 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9160 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9161 possible that the client has already brought one.
9162
9163 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9164 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9165 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9166 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9167 header and requires different one.
9168
9169 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9170 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9171 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009172 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9173 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9174 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9175 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9176 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009177
9178 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9179 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9180 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9181 both are defined.
9182
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009183 Examples :
9184 # Original Destination address
9185 frontend www
9186 mode http
9187 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9188
9189 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9190 backend www
9191 mode http
9192 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009194 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009195
9196
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009197option persist
9198no option persist
9199 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9200 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9201 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009202 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009203
9204 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9205 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9206 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9207 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9208 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9209 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9210 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9211 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9212 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9213 redirected to another valid server.
9214
9215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9217
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009218 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009219
9220
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009221option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9222 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | no | yes | yes
9225 Arguments :
9226 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9227 PostgreSQL server.
9228
9229 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9230 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9231 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9232 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9233
9234 See also: "option httpchk"
9235
9236
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009237option prefer-last-server
9238no option prefer-last-server
9239 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9241 yes | no | yes | yes
9242 Arguments : none
9243
9244 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009245 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009246 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9247 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009248 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009249 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009250 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009251 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9252 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009253 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009254 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009255 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9256 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9257 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009258 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9259 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9260 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009261
9262 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9263 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9264
9265 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9266
9267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009268option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009269option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009270no option redispatch
9271 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9273 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009274 Arguments :
9275 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9276 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9277 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009278 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009279 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009280 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009281 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9282 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9283 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009285
9286 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9287 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9288 be able to access the service anymore.
9289
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009290 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9291 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009292
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009293 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9294 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9295 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9296 following order:
9297
9298 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9299
9300 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9301 list, or
9302
9303 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9304
9305 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9306 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9307
9308 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9309 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9310 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9311 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9312
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009313 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009314 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9315 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9319
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009320 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009321
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009322
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009323option redis-check
9324 Use redis health checks for server testing
9325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9326 yes | no | yes | yes
9327 Arguments : none
9328
9329 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9330 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9331 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9332 find the "+PONG" response message.
9333
9334 Example :
9335 option redis-check
9336
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009337 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009338
9339
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009340option smtpchk
9341option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9342 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009346 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009347 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009348 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9349
9350 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9351 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9352 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9353
9354 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9355 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9356 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9357 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9358 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9359 dead server.
9360
9361 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9362 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009363 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009364 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9365
9366 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9367 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9368 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9369 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009370 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009371
9372 Example :
9373 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9374
9375 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009378option socket-stats
9379no option socket-stats
9380
9381 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 yes | yes | yes | no
9384
9385 Arguments : none
9386
9387
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009388option splice-auto
9389no option splice-auto
9390 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9392 yes | yes | yes | yes
9393 Arguments : none
9394
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009395 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009396 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009397 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009398 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009399 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009400 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9401 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9402 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9403 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9404
9405 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9406 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9407 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9408 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9409 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9410 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9411 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9412 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9413 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9414 keyword.
9415
9416 Example :
9417 option splice-auto
9418
9419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9421
9422 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9423 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9424
9425
9426option splice-request
9427no option splice-request
9428 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | yes | yes | yes
9431 Arguments : none
9432
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009433 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009434 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009435 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9436 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9437 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9438 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9439
9440 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9441
9442 Example :
9443 option splice-request
9444
9445 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9446 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9447
9448 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9449 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9450
9451
9452option splice-response
9453no option splice-response
9454 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9456 yes | yes | yes | yes
9457 Arguments : none
9458
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009459 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009460 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009461 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9462 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9463 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9464 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9465
9466 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9467
9468 Example :
9469 option splice-response
9470
9471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9473
9474 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9475 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9476
9477
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009478option spop-check
9479 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9481 no | no | no | yes
9482 Arguments : none
9483
9484 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9485 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9486 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9487 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9488
9489 Example :
9490 option spop-check
9491
9492 See also : "option httpchk"
9493
9494
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009495option srvtcpka
9496no option srvtcpka
9497 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9499 yes | no | yes | yes
9500 Arguments : none
9501
9502 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9503 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009504 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009505 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9506
9507 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9508 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9509 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9510 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9511
9512 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9513 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9514 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9515 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9516 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9517
9518 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9519
9520 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9521 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9522 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9523
9524 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9525 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9526
9527 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9528
9529
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009530option ssl-hello-chk
9531 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9533 yes | no | yes | yes
9534 Arguments : none
9535
9536 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9537 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9538 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9539 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9540 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9541 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9542 hello message.
9543
9544 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9545 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9546 messages, which is appreciable.
9547
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009548 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009549 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9550 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009551
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009552 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9553
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009554
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009555option tcp-check
9556 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9558 yes | no | yes | yes
9559
9560 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9561 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9562
9563 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9564 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9565 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9566
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009567 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009568 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9569 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9570 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9571 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9572 only.
9573
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009574 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009575 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009576 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9577 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9578 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9579
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009580 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009581 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9582 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009583 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009584 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9585 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9586 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9587 the respective protocols.
9588 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009589 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009590
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009591 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009592
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009593 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9594 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9595 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9596 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009598 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9599 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9600 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009601
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009602
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009603 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009604 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009605 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009606 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009607
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009609 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009610 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009611
9612 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9613 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009614 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009615 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009616 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009617 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009618 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009619 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9621 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009622 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009623 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9624 tcp-check expect string +OK
9625
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009626 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009627 (send many headers before analyzing)
9628 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009629 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009630 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9631 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9632 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9633 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009634 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009635
9636
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009637 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009638
9639
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009640option tcp-smart-accept
9641no option tcp-smart-accept
9642 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9644 yes | yes | yes | no
9645 Arguments : none
9646
9647 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9648 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9649 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9650 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9651 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9652 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9653
9654 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9655 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9656 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9657 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9658
9659 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9660 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9661 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009662 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009663
9664 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9665 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9666 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9667
9668 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9669 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9670 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9671
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009672 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9673
9674
9675option tcp-smart-connect
9676no option tcp-smart-connect
9677 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9679 yes | no | yes | yes
9680 Arguments : none
9681
9682 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9683 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9684 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9685 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9686 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9687
9688 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9689 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9690 complex.
9691
9692 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9693 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9694 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9695
9696 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9697 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9698
9699 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9700
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009701
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009702option tcpka
9703 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9705 yes | yes | yes | yes
9706 Arguments : none
9707
9708 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9709 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009710 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009711 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9712
9713 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9714 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9715 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9716 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9717
9718 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9719 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9720 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9721 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9722 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9723
9724 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9725
9726 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9727 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9728 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9729 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9730 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9731 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9732 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9733 backends.
9734
9735 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9736
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009737
9738option tcplog
9739 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009741 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009742 Arguments : none
9743
9744 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9745 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9746 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9747 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9748 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9749 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9750 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9751 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9752
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009753 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009755 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009756
9757
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009758option transparent
9759no option transparent
9760 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009762 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009763 Arguments : none
9764
9765 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9766 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9767 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9768 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9769 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9770 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9771 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9772 appropriate server.
9773
9774 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9775 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9776
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009777 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009778 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009779
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009780
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009781external-check command <command>
9782 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9784 yes | no | yes | yes
9785
9786 Arguments :
9787 <command> is the external command to run
9788
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009789 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9790
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009791 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009792
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009793 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9794 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9795 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9796 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9797 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9798 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009799
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009800 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9801
9802 Environment variables :
9803 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9804 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9805
9806 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9807
9808 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9809
9810 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9811 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9812 for a UNIX socket).
9813
9814 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9815
9816 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9817
9818 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9819
9820 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9821
9822 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9823
9824 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9825 socket).
9826
9827 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9828 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9829
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009830 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9831
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009832 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9833 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9834 failed.
9835
9836 Example :
9837 external-check command /bin/true
9838
9839 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9840
9841
9842external-check path <path>
9843 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9845 yes | no | yes | yes
9846
9847 Arguments :
9848 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9849
9850 The default path is "".
9851
9852 Example :
9853 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9854
9855 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9856 "external-check command"
9857
9858
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009859persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009860persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009861 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9863 yes | no | yes | yes
9864 Arguments :
9865 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009866 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9867 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009868
9869 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9870 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009871 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009872 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9873 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9874 forwarded to this server.
9875
9876 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9877 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9878 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009879 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009880 a single "listen" section.
9881
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009882 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9883 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9884 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9885
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009886 Example :
9887 listen tse-farm
9888 bind :3389
9889 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9890 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9891 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9892 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9893 persist rdp-cookie
9894 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009895 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009896 balance rdp-cookie
9897 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9898 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9899
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009900 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9901 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009902
9903
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009904rate-limit sessions <rate>
9905 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9907 yes | yes | yes | no
9908 Arguments :
9909 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9910 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9911
9912 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9913 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9914 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009915 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009916 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9917 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9918
9919 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9920 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9921 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9922 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9923
9924 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9925 listen smtp
9926 mode tcp
9927 bind :25
9928 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009929 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009930
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009931 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9932 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9933 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009934
9935 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9936
9937
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009938redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9939redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9940redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009941 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9943 no | yes | yes | yes
9944
9945 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009946 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009947
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009948 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009949 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009950 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9951 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9952 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009953
9954 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9955 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9956 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9957 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9958 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009959 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9960 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9961 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9962 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009963
9964 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9965 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9966 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9967 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9968 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9969 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009970 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009971 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009972 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9973 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9974 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009975
9976 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009977 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9978 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9979 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009980 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009981 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9982 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9983 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9984 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009985
9986 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009988
9989 - "drop-query"
9990 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9991 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9992 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9993 with a location-type redirect.
9994
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009995 - "append-slash"
9996 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9997 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9998 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9999 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10000
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010001 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10002 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10003 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10004 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10005 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10006 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10007 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10008
10009 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10010 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10011 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10012 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10013 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10014 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10015 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010016
10017 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10018 acl clear dst_port 80
10019 acl secure dst_port 8080
10020 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010021 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010022 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010023 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10024
10025 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010026 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10027 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10028 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010029 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010030
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010031 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10032 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10033 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10034
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010035 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010036 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010037
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010038 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010039 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10040 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10041 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010043 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010044
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010045
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010046retries <value>
10047 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10049 yes | no | yes | yes
10050 Arguments :
10051 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10052 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10053 default value is 3.
10054
10055 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10056 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10057 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10058
10059 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010060 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10061 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010062
10063 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10064 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10065
10066 See also : "option redispatch"
10067
10068
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010069retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010070 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10071 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10072 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10074 yes | no | yes | yes
10075 Arguments :
10076 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10077 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10078 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10079 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10080
10081 none never retry
10082
10083 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10084 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10085
10086 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10087 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10088 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10089 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10090 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10091 processing the request.
10092
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010093 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10094 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10095 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10096 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10097 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10098 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10099 overflow attack for example).
10100
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010101 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10102 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10103 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10104 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10105 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10106 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10107 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10108 amplify denial of service attacks.
10109
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010110 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10111 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10112 considered to be safe to retry.
10113
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010114 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10115 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10116 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10117 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10118 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010119
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010120 all-retryable-errors
10121 retry request for any error that are considered
10122 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10123 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10124 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10125
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010126 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10127 not cumulative.
10128
10129 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10130 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10131 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10132 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10133
10134 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10135 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10136 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10137 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10138 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10139 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10140 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10141 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10142 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10143 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10144 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10145 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10146
10147 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10148 should not use this directive.
10149
10150 The default is "conn-failure".
10151
10152 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10153
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010154server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 Declare a server in a backend
10156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10157 no | no | yes | yes
10158 Arguments :
10159 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010160 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010161 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010162
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010163 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10164 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10165 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10166 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010167 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10168 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010169 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010170 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10171 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010172 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10173 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10174 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10175 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10176 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10177 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10178 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010179 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010180 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10181 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10182 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10183 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10184 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10185 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010186 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10187 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010188 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10189 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010190
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010191 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010192 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10193 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10194 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10195 adding this value to the client's port.
10196
10197 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10198 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010199 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010200
10201 Examples :
10202 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10203 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010204 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010205 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10206 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10207 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010208
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010209 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10210 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10211 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10212 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10213 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10214
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010215 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10216 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010217
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010218server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010219 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010220 this backend.
10221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 no | no | yes | yes
10223
10224 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10225 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10226 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10227 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10228 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010229
10230 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10231 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10232
10233 global
10234 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10235
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010236 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010237 load-server-state-from-file
10238
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010239 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010240 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010241
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010242server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10243 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10244 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10246 no | no | yes | yes
10247
10248 Arguments:
10249 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10250
10251 <num | range>
10252 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10253 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10254 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10255 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10256
10257 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10258
10259 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10260
10261 <params*>
10262 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10263 keyword.
10264
10265 Examples:
10266 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10267 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10268 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10269
10270 # or
10271 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10272
10273 # would be equivalent to:
10274 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10275 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10276 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10277
10278
10279
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010280source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010281source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010282source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010283 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10285 yes | no | yes | yes
10286 Arguments :
10287 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10288 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010289
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010290 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010291 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10292 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10293 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10294 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10295 supported prefixes are :
10296 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10297 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10298 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010299 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010300 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10301 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010302
10303 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10304 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010305 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10306 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10307 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010308
10309 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10310 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10311 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10312 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10313 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10314 <addr>.
10315
10316 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10317 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10318 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10319 port.
10320
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010321 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10322 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10323 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10324 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010325 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010326 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10327 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10328 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10329 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10330 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10331 HTTP header.
10332
10333 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10334 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010335 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010336 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10337 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10338 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10339 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10340 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10341 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10342 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10343
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010344 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10345 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10346 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10347 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10348 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10349 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10350
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010351 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10352 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10353 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10354 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10355
10356 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10357 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10358 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10359 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10360 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10361 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10362
10363 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10364 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10365 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10366 there are two methods :
10367
10368 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10369 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10370 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10371 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10372 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10373 of the client ranges may be used.
10374
10375 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10376 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10377 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10378 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10379 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10380 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10381 same session.
10382
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010383 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10384 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10385 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010386 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010387
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010388 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010390 Examples :
10391 backend private
10392 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10393 source 192.168.1.200
10394
10395 backend transparent_ssl1
10396 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10397 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10398
10399 backend transparent_ssl2
10400 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10401 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10402 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10403
10404 backend transparent_ssl3
10405 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10406 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10407 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10408
10409 backend transparent_smtp
10410 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10411 # with Tproxy version 4.
10412 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10413
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010414 backend transparent_http
10415 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10416 # proxy.
10417 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010419 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010420 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10421
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010422
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010423srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10424 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10425 the connection on the server side.
10426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10427 yes | no | yes | yes
10428 Arguments :
10429 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10430
10431 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10432 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010433 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10434 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010435
10436 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10437
10438
10439srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10440 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10441 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10442 server side.
10443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10444 yes | no | yes | yes
10445 Arguments :
10446 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10447 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10448 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10449 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10450
10451 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10452 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010453 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10454 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010455
10456 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10457
10458
10459srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10460 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10462 yes | no | yes | yes
10463 Arguments :
10464 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10465 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10466 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10467 document.
10468
10469 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10470 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010471 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10472 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010473
10474 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10475
10476
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010477stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10478 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010480 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010481
10482 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10483 matched.
10484
10485 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10486 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10487
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010488 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10489 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10490 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10491 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010492
10493 Example :
10494 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10495 backend stats_localhost
10496 stats enable
10497 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10498
10499 Example :
10500 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10501 backend stats_auth
10502 stats enable
10503 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10504 stats admin if TRUE
10505
10506 Example :
10507 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10508 userlist stats-auth
10509 group admin users admin
10510 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10511 group readonly users haproxy
10512 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10513
10514 backend stats_auth
10515 stats enable
10516 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10517 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10518 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10519 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10520
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010521 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10522 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010523
10524
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010525stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10526 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010528 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010529 Arguments :
10530 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10531
10532 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10533
10534 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10535 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10536 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10537 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10538 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10539 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10540
10541 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10542 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10543 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010544 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010545
10546 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10547 report using "stats scope".
10548
10549 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10550 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10551 unobvious parameters.
10552
10553 Example :
10554 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10555 backend public_www
10556 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10557 stats enable
10558 stats hide-version
10559 stats scope .
10560 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010561 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010562 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10563 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10564
10565 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10566 backend private_monitoring
10567 stats enable
10568 stats uri /admin?stats
10569 stats refresh 5s
10570
10571 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10572
10573
10574stats enable
10575 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010577 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010578 Arguments : none
10579
10580 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10581 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10582 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10583 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10584 - stats auth : no authentication
10585 - stats scope : no restriction
10586
10587 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10588 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10589 unobvious parameters.
10590
10591 Example :
10592 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10593 backend public_www
10594 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10595 stats enable
10596 stats hide-version
10597 stats scope .
10598 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010599 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010600 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10601 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10602
10603 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10604 backend private_monitoring
10605 stats enable
10606 stats uri /admin?stats
10607 stats refresh 5s
10608
10609 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10610
10611
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010612stats hide-version
10613 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010615 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010616 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010617
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010618 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10619 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10620 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10621 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10622 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10623 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010625 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10626 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10627 unobvious parameters.
10628
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010629 Example :
10630 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10631 backend public_www
10632 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010633 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010634 stats hide-version
10635 stats scope .
10636 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010637 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010638 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10639 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010640
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010641 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10642 backend private_monitoring
10643 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010644 stats uri /admin?stats
10645 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010646
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010647 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010648
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010649
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010650stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10651 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10652 Access control for statistics
10653
10654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10655 no | no | yes | yes
10656
10657 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10658 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10659 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10660 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10661 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10662 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10663
10664 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10665 instance.
10666
10667 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10668 about ACL usage.
10669
10670
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010671stats realm <realm>
10672 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010674 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010675 Arguments :
10676 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10677 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10678 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10679
10680 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10681 using a backslash ('\').
10682
10683 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10684 only related to authentication.
10685
10686 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10687 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10688 unobvious parameters.
10689
10690 Example :
10691 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10692 backend public_www
10693 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10694 stats enable
10695 stats hide-version
10696 stats scope .
10697 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010698 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010699 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10700 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10701
10702 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10703 backend private_monitoring
10704 stats enable
10705 stats uri /admin?stats
10706 stats refresh 5s
10707
10708 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10709
10710
10711stats refresh <delay>
10712 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010714 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010715 Arguments :
10716 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10717 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10718 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10719 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10720 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10721 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10722
10723 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10724 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10725 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010726 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010727
10728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10730 unobvious parameters.
10731
10732 Example :
10733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10734 backend public_www
10735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10736 stats enable
10737 stats hide-version
10738 stats scope .
10739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10743
10744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10745 backend private_monitoring
10746 stats enable
10747 stats uri /admin?stats
10748 stats refresh 5s
10749
10750 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10751
10752
10753stats scope { <name> | "." }
10754 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010757 Arguments :
10758 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10759 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10760 section in which the statement appears.
10761
10762 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10763 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10764 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10765 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10766 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10767 exists.
10768
10769 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10770 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10771 unobvious parameters.
10772
10773 Example :
10774 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10775 backend public_www
10776 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10777 stats enable
10778 stats hide-version
10779 stats scope .
10780 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010781 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010782 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10783 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10784
10785 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10786 backend private_monitoring
10787 stats enable
10788 stats uri /admin?stats
10789 stats refresh 5s
10790
10791 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010793
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010794stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010797 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010798
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010799 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010800 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10801
10802 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10803 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10804
10805 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10806 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010807 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808
10809 Example :
10810 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10811 backend private_monitoring
10812 stats enable
10813 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10814 stats uri /admin?stats
10815 stats refresh 5s
10816
10817 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10818 global section.
10819
10820
10821stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010822 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10824 yes | yes | yes | yes
10825 Arguments : none
10826
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010827 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010828 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10829 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10830 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10831 - IP (socket, server)
10832 - cookie (backend, server)
10833
10834 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10835 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010836 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010837
10838 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10839
10840
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010841stats show-modules
10842 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10844 yes | yes | yes | yes
10845 Arguments : none
10846
10847 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10848 values as a tooltip.
10849
10850 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10851 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10852 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10853
10854 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10855
10856
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010857stats show-node [ <name> ]
10858 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010860 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010861 Arguments:
10862 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10863 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10864
10865 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10866 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010867 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010868
10869 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10870 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10871 unobvious parameters.
10872
10873 Example:
10874 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10875 backend private_monitoring
10876 stats enable
10877 stats show-node Europe-1
10878 stats uri /admin?stats
10879 stats refresh 5s
10880
10881 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10882 section.
10883
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010884
10885stats uri <prefix>
10886 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889 Arguments :
10890 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10891 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10892 query string.
10893
10894 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10895 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10896 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10897 possible to reach it in the application.
10898
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010899 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010900 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010901 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10902 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10903 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10904 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10905
10906 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10907 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10908 an address or a port to statistics only.
10909
10910 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10911 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10912 unobvious parameters.
10913
10914 Example :
10915 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10916 backend public_www
10917 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10918 stats enable
10919 stats hide-version
10920 stats scope .
10921 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010923 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10924 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10925
10926 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10927 backend private_monitoring
10928 stats enable
10929 stats uri /admin?stats
10930 stats refresh 5s
10931
10932 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10933
10934
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010935stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10936 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010939
10940 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010941 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010942 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010944 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10945
10946 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10947 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10948 the "stick-table" statement.
10949
10950 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10951 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10952 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10953 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10954 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10955
10956 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10957 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10958 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10959 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10960 transformation rules.
10961
10962 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10963 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10964 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10965 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10966 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10967 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10968 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10969
10970 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10971 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10972 ACL based conditions.
10973
10974 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10975 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10976 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10977 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10978
10979 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10980 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10981 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10982 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10983
10984 Example :
10985 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10986 # last 30 minutes
10987 backend pop
10988 mode tcp
10989 balance roundrobin
10990 stick store-request src
10991 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10992 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10993 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10994
10995 backend smtp
10996 mode tcp
10997 balance roundrobin
10998 stick match src table pop
10999 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11000 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11001
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011002 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11003 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011004
11005
11006stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11007 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11009 no | no | yes | yes
11010
11011 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11012 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11013 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11014 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11015
11016 Examples :
11017 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011018 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011019
11020 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11021 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11022 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11023
11024
11025 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11026 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11027 backend http
11028 mode http
11029 balance roundrobin
11030 stick on src table https
11031 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11032 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11033 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11034
11035 backend https
11036 mode tcp
11037 balance roundrobin
11038 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11039 stick on src
11040 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11041 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11042
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011043 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011044
11045
11046stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11047 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11049 no | no | yes | yes
11050
11051 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011052 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011053 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011055 server is selected.
11056
11057 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11058 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11059 the "stick-table" statement.
11060
11061 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11062 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11063 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11064 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11065 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11066 address.
11067
11068 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11069 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11070 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11071 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11072 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11073 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11074 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11075 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11076 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11077 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11078
11079 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11080 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11081 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11082 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11083 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11084 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11085 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11086
11087 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11088 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11089 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11090 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11091
11092 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11093 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11094 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11095 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11096 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11097 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011098 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11099 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11100 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11101 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11102 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11103 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011104
11105 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11106 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11107 the request.
11108
11109 Example :
11110 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11111 # last 30 minutes
11112 backend pop
11113 mode tcp
11114 balance roundrobin
11115 stick store-request src
11116 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11117 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11118 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11119
11120 backend smtp
11121 mode tcp
11122 balance roundrobin
11123 stick match src table pop
11124 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11125 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11126
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011127 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011128
11129
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011130stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011131 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011132 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011133 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011135 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011136
11137 Arguments :
11138 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11139 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11140 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11141 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11142
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011143 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11144 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11145 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11146 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11147
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011148 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11149 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11150 instance.
11151
11152 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11153 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11154 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11155 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11156 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11157 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011158 to 32 characters.
11159
11160 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11161 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11162 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011163 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011164 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11165 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011166
11167 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011168 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11169 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011170 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11171 increase.
11172
11173 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011174 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11175 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11176 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011177
11178 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011179 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011180 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11181 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011182 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011183 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11184 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11185 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11186 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11187 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11188 parameter (see below).
11189
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011190 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11191 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11192 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11193 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11194 soft restart.
11195
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011196 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11197 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11198 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11199 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011200 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011201 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011202 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11203 if not expiration delay is specified.
11204
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011205 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11206 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11207 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11208 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11209 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11210 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11211 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11212 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11213 token.
11214
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011215 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11216 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11217 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11218 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011219 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11220 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11221 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11222 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11223 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11224 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11225 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11226 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11227 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11228 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11229 types and their arguments.
11230
11231 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11232 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11233 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11234 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11235
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011236 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11237 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11238 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11239 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11240 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11241 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11242 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11243 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11244 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11245 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011246 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11247 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11248 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11249 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011250
11251 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11252 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11253 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11254 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11255 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11256 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11257 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11258 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11259 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11260 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11261 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11262 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011263 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11264 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11265 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11266 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011267
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011268 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11269 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11270 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011271 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011272
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011273 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11274 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11275 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011276 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011277 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011278 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011279
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011280 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11281 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11282 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11283 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11284
11285 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11286 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11287 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11288 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11289 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11290 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11291
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011292 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11293 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11294 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11295 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11296 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11297 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11298 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11299 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11300 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11301 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011302 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11303 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11304 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011305
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011306 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11307 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11308 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11309 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11310
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011311 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11312 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11313 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11314 they were received.
11315
11316 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11317 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11318 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11319 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11320 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11321
11322 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11323 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11324 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11325 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11326 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11327
11328 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11329 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11330 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11331
11332 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11333 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11334 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11335 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11336 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11337
11338 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11339 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11340 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11341 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11342 the client side.
11343
11344 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11345 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11346 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11347 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11348 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11349 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11350 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11351
11352 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11353 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11354 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11355 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11356 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11357 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011358 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011359
11360 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11361 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11362 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11363 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11364 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11365 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11366
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011367 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11368 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11369 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11370 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11371 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11372
11373 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11374 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11375 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11376 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11377 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11378 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11379
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011380 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011381 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011382 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11383 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11384
11385 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11386 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11387 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11388 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11389 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11390 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11391 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11392 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11393 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11394 recommended for better fairness.
11395
11396 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011397 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011398 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11399 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11400
11401 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11402 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11403 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11404 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11405 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11406 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11407 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11408 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11409 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11410 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011411
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011412 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11413 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011414 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11415 reference it.
11416
11417 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11418 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011419 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11420 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11421 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011422
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011423 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11424 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11425 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11426 something that can be ignored.
11427
11428 Example:
11429 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11430 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11431 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11432 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11433
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011434 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011435 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011436
11437
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011438stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011439 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11441 no | no | yes | yes
11442
11443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011444 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011445 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011446 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011447 server is selected.
11448
11449 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11450 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11451 the "stick-table" statement.
11452
11453 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11454 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11455 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11456 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11457
11458 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11459 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11460 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11461 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11462 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11463 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011464 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011465 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11466 rules.
11467
11468 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11469 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11470 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11471 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11472 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11473 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11474 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11475
11476 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11477 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11478 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11479 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11480
11481 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11482 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11483 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11484 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11485 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11486 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011487 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11488 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11489 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11490 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11491 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11492 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11493 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11494 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11495 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011496
11497 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11498
11499 Example :
11500 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11501 backend https
11502 mode tcp
11503 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011504 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011505 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011506
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011507 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11508 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11509
11510 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11511 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11512 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11513
11514 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11515 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011516
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011517 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11518 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11519 # at offset 44.
11520
11521 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11522 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11523
11524 # Learn on response if server hello.
11525 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011526
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011527 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11528 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11529
11530 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11531 extraction.
11532
11533
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011534tcp-check comment <string>
11535 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11536 it fails.
11537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11538 yes | no | yes | yes
11539
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011540 Arguments :
11541 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11542 rule fails.
11543
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011544 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11545 user-friendly error reporting.
11546
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011547 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11548 "tcp-check expect".
11549
11550
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011551tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11552 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011553 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011554 Opens a new connection
11555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011556 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011557
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011558 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011559 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11560
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011561 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011562 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011563
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011564 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011565 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11566 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011567 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011568
11569 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011570
11571 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11572
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011573 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11574
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011575 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11576
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011577 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11578
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011579 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11580 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11581 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11582 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11583
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011584 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11585 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11586 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11587 haproxy -vv.
11588
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011589 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011590
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011591 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11592 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11593 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11594
11595 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11596 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11597 of the sequence.
11598
11599 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11600 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11601 do.
11602
11603 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11604 unset-var or comment rules.
11605
11606 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011607 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11608 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11609 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11610 option tcp-check
11611 tcp-check connect
11612 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11613 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11614 tcp-check send \r\n
11615 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11616 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11617 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11618 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11619 tcp-check send \r\n
11620 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11621 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11622
11623 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11624 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011625 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011626 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11627 tcp-check connect port 143
11628 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11629 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11630
11631 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11632
11633
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011634tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011635 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011636 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011637 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011638 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011640 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011641
11642 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011643 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11644
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011645 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11646 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11647 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11648 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11649 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11650 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11651 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11652 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11653 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11654 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11655
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011656 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011657 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11658 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011659 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11660 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11661 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11662
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011663 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11664 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11665 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011666 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11667 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011668 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11669 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011670 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11671 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011672 By default "L7OK" is used.
11673
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011674 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11675 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011676 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11677 supported :
11678 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11679 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011680 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11681 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11682 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11683 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11684 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011685
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011686 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011687 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011688 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11689 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11690 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11691 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011692 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11693
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011694 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11695 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11696 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11697 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11698
11699 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11700 informational message reported in logs if an error
11701 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11702 log-format string.
11703
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011704 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11705 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11706 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11707 followed by some converters.
11708
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011709 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11710 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11711 with the usual backslash ('\').
11712 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011713 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011714 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11715 used upper or lower case.
11716
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011717 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11718
11719 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11720 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11721 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11722 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11723 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11724 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11725 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11726 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11727
11728 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11729 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11730 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11731 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11732 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11733 expression.
11734
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011735 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11736 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11737 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11738 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11739 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11740 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11741
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11743 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11744 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11745 this exact hexadecimal string.
11746 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11747
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011748 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11749 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11750 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11751 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11752 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11753 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11754 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11755 size.
11756
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011757 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11758 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11759 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11760 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11761 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11762 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11763 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11764 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11765 in a binary string before matching the response's
11766 buffer.
11767
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011768 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011769 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011770 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11771 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11772 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11773 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11774 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11775 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11776 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11777 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11778 the null character.
11779
11780 Examples :
11781 # perform a POP check
11782 option tcp-check
11783 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11784
11785 # perform an IMAP check
11786 option tcp-check
11787 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11788
11789 # look for the redis master server
11790 option tcp-check
11791 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011792 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011793 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11794 tcp-check expect string role:master
11795 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11796 tcp-check expect string +OK
11797
11798
11799 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011800 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011801
11802
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011803tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11804tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11805 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11806 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011809
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011810 Arguments :
11811 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11812
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011813 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11814 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011815
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011816 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11817 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818
11819 Examples :
11820 # look for the redis master server
11821 option tcp-check
11822 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11823 tcp-check expect string role:master
11824
11825 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011826 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011827
11828
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011829tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11830tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11831 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11832 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011834 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011835
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011836 Arguments :
11837 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011838
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011839 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11840 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011841
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011842 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11843 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11844 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011845
11846 Examples :
11847 # redis check in binary
11848 option tcp-check
11849 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11850 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11851
11852
11853 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011854 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855
11856
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011857tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011858 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011860 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011861
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011862 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011863 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11864 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11867 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11868 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11869 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11870 and '-'.
11871
11872 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11873
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011874 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011875 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11876
11877
11878tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011879 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011881 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011882
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011883 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011884 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11885 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11886 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11887 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11888 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11889 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11890 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11891 and '-'.
11892
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011893 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011894 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11895
11896
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011897tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11898 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11900 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011901 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011902 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11903 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011905 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011906
11907 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11908 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011909 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11910 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11911 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11912 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11913 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11914 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11917 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11918 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11919 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011920
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011921 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011922 - accept :
11923 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11924 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11925 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011927 - reject :
11928 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11929 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11930 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11931 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11932 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11933 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11934 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11935 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11936 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11937 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11938 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011939 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011940
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011941 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11942 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11943 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11944 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11945 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11946 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11947 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11948 hosts.
11949
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011950 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11951 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11952 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11953 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11954 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11955 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11956 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11957 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11958
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011959 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11960 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11961 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11962 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11963 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11964 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11965 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11966 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11967 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011968 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11969 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011970
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011971 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011972 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011973 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11974 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11975 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011976 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011977 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011978 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11979 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11980 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11981 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11982 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11983 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11984 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011986 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011987 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011988 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011989 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011990 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11991 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11992 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011994 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11995 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11996 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11997 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011999 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12000 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12001 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12002 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12003 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012004 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12005 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12006 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12007 layer7 information is extracted.
12008
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012009 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12010 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12011 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12012 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12013 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012014
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012015 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12016 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12017 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12018 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12019 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12020 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12021 no GPC stored at this index.
12022 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12023 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12024 data_types).
12025
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012026 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12027 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12028 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12029 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12030
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012031 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12032 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12033 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12034 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12035
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012036 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12037 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12038 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12039 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12040 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12041 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12042 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12043 no GPT stored at this index.
12044 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12045 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12046
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012047 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12048 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12049 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12050 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12051 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012052
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012053 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012054 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12055 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12056 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12057 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12058 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12059 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12060 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12061 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012062 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012063
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012064 - set-src <expr> :
12065 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12066 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12067 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012068 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012070 Arguments:
12071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12072 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012073
12074 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012075 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12076
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012077 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12078 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012079
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012080 - set-src-port <expr> :
12081 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12082 expression.
12083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012084 Arguments:
12085 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12086 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012087
12088 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012089 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12090
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012091 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12092 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12093 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012094
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012095 - set-dst <expr> :
12096 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12097 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12098 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12099 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12100 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12101
12102 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12103 followed by some converters.
12104
12105 Example:
12106
12107 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12108 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12109
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012110 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12111 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12112
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012113 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12114 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12115 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12116 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12117
12118
12119 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12120 followed by some converters.
12121
12122 Example:
12123
12124 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12125
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012126 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12127 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12128 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12129
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012130 - set-tos <tos>:
12131 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12132 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12133 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12134 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12135 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12136 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12137 routers based on some information from the request.
12138
12139 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12140
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012141 - "silent-drop" :
12142 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012143 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012144 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12145 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12146 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12147 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12148 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012149 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12150 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012151 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12152 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012153 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012154 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12155 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12156 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12157 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012159 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12160 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12161 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012163 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12164 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12165 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012167 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012168 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012169 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012170
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012171 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12172 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12173 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012175 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012176 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12177 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012178
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012179 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12180
12181 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12182
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012183 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12184
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012185 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012186
12187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012188tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12189 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012191 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012192 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012193 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12194 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012196 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012197
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012198 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012199 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12200 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012201 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12202 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012204 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12205 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12206 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12207 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012208 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012209 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012210 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12211 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12212 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12213 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012214 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012215 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012217 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12218 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12219 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12220 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012221
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012222 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012223 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012224 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012225 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12226 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012227 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012228 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012229 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012230 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012231 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012232 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012233 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012234 - set-dst <expr>
12235 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012236 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012237 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012238 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012239 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012240 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012241 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012242 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012243 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012244 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012245 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012246
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012247 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12248 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012249 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12250 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012251
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012252 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12253 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12254 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12255 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12256 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12257 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012259 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012260 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12261 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012262
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012263 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12264 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12265 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12266 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12267 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12268 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12269
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012270 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012271 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12272 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12273 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12274 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12275 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12276 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12277 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12278 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12279 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12280 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012281
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012282 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012283 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12284 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12285 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012286
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012287 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12288 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12289
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012290 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12291 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12292
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012293 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12294 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12295
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012296 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12297 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12298
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012299 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12300 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12301
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012302 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012303 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12304 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012305
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012306 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12307 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012308 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012311 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012312 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012313 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12315 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012317 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12318 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012319
12320 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12321 followed by some converters.
12322
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012323 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012324 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12325 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12326 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12327 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12328 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12329 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012330 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012331 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12332 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12333
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012334 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12335
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012336 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12337 <var-name>.
12338
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012339 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12340 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12341 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12342 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12343 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12344
12345 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12346 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12347 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12348 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12349 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12350 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12351 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12352 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12353 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12354 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12355 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12356
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012357 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12358 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12359 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12360 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12361 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12362
12363 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12364
12365 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12366
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012367 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12368 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12369 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12370 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12371 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12372 evaluated.
12373
12374 Example:
12375 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12376
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012377 Example:
12378
12379 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012380 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012381
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012382 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012383 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012384 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012385 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12386 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012387 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012388 tcp-request content reject
12389
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012390 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12391 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12392 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12393 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12394 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12395 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12396 ...
12397 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12398
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012399 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012400 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12401 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12402 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012403 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012404
12405 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12406 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12407 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012408 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012409 tcp-request content reject
12410
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012411 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012412 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012413 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012414 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012415 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12416 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012417
12418 Example:
12419 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12420 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012421 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012422
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012423 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012424 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012425
12426 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012427 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012428 # protecting all our sites
12429 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012430 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12431 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012432 ...
12433 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12434
12435 backend http_dynamic
12436 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012437 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012438 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012439 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012440 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012441 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012442 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012444 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012445
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012446 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12447 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012448
12449
12450tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12451 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012453 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012454 Arguments :
12455 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12456 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12457 as explained at the top of this document.
12458
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012459 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012460 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12461 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12462 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12463 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12464
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012465 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12466 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12467 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12468 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12469
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012470 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012471 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012472 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012473 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012474 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012475 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12476 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12477 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012478
12479 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12480 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12481 it pass through unaffected.
12482
12483 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12484 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12485 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012486 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012487 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12488 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012489 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12490 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12491 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012492
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012493 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012494 "timeout client".
12495
12496
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012497tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12498 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12500 no | no | yes | yes
12501 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012502 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12503 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012504
12505 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012507 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012508 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12509 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012510 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12511 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012512
12513 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12514
12515 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12516 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12517 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12518 inserted.
12519
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012520 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012521 - accept :
12522 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12523 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12524 the rules evaluation.
12525
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012526 - close :
12527 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12528 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12529 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12530 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12531 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12532 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012533 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012534 protocols.
12535
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012536 - reject :
12537 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12538 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012539 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012540
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012541 - set-log-level <level>
12542 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12543 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12544 set-log-level".
12545
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012546 - set-mark <mark>
12547 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12548 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12549 set-mark".
12550
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012551 - set-nice <nice>
12552 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12553 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12554 set-nice".
12555
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012556 - set-tos <tos>
12557 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12558 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12559 set-tos".
12560
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012561 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12562 Sets a variable.
12563
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012564 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12565 Unsets a variable.
12566
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012567 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12568 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12569 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12570 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12571 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12572 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12573 no GPC stored at this index.
12574 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12575 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12576 data_types).
12577
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012578 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12579 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12580 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12581 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12582
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012583 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12584 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12585 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12586 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12587
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012588 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12589 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12590 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12591 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12592 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12593 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12594 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12595 no GPT stored at this index.
12596 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12597 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12598
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012599 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12600 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12601 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12602 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12603 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012604
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012605 - "silent-drop" :
12606 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012607 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012608 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12609 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12610 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12611 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12612 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012613 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12614 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012615 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12616 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012617 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012618 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12619 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12620 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12621 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12622
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012623 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12624 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12625
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012626 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12627 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12628 for changing the default action to a reject.
12629
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012630 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12631 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12632 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12633 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012634 period.
12635
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012636 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12637 declared inline.
12638
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012639 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12640 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012644 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012645 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012646 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012647 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12648 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012649 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012650 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12651 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012652
12653 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12654 followed by some converters.
12655
12656 Example:
12657
12658 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12659
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012660 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12661 <var-name>.
12662
12663 Example:
12664
12665 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12666
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012667 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12668 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12669 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12670 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12671 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12672
12673 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12674
12675 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12676
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012677 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12678
12679 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12680
12681
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012682tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12683 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12685 no | yes | yes | no
12686 Arguments :
12687 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12688 below.
12689
12690 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012693 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12694 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12695 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12696 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12697 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12698 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12699 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012700 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012701 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12702 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12703 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12704 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12705 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12706 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12707 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12708 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12709 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12710 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12711 instead.
12712
12713 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12714 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12715 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12716 rules which may be inserted.
12717
12718 Several types of actions are supported :
12719 - accept : the request is accepted
12720 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12721 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012722 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012723 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012724 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012725 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012726 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012727 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012728 - set-dst <expr>
12729 - set-dst-port <expr>
12730 - set-src <expr>
12731 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012732 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012733 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012734 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012735 - silent-drop
12736
12737 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12738 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12739 sections for a complete description.
12740
12741 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12742 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12743 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12744
12745 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12746 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12747 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12748 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12749 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12750
12751 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12752 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12753
12754 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12755 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12756 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12757
12758 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12759 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12760 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12761
12762 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12763 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12764 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12765
12766 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12767 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12768 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12769
12770 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12771
12772 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12773
12774
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012775tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12776 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12778 no | no | yes | yes
12779 Arguments :
12780 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12782 as explained at the top of this document.
12783
12784 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12785
12786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012787timeout check <timeout>
12788 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12789 established.
12790
12791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12792 yes | no | yes | yes
12793 Arguments:
12794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12796 as explained at the top of this document.
12797
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012798 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012799 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012800 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012801 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012802 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12803 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12804 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012805
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012806 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012807 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12808
12809 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12810 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012811 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012812
12813 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12814 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12815 forget about it.
12816
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012817 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12818 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012819
12820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012821timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012822 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12824 yes | yes | yes | no
12825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12828 as explained at the top of this document.
12829
12830 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12831 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12832 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012833 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12834 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12835 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12836 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012837 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12838 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12839 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012840 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012841 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012842 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12843 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012844 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12845 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012846
12847 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012851 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12853
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012854 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012855
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012856 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012858
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012859timeout client-fin <timeout>
12860 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12862 yes | yes | yes | no
12863 Arguments :
12864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12866 as explained at the top of this document.
12867
12868 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12869 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12870 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12871 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12872 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12873 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12874 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012875 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12876 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12877 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012878
12879 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12880 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12881 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12882
12883 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12884
12885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012887 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12889 yes | no | yes | yes
12890 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012891 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012892 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12893 as explained at the top of this document.
12894
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012895 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012896 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012897 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012898 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012899 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12900 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012901
12902 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12903 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12904 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12905 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012906 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12908
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012909 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012910
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012912timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12913 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12915 yes | yes | yes | yes
12916 Arguments :
12917 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12918 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12919 as explained at the top of this document.
12920
12921 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12922 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12923 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12924 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12925 once the request has started to present itself.
12926
12927 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12928 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12929 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12930 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12931 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12932
12933 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12934 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12935 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12936 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12937
12938 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12939 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012940 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012941 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12942 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012943 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012944
12945 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12946 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12947 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12948 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12949
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012950 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12951 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012952 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12953
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012954 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12955
12956
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012957timeout http-request <timeout>
12958 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012960 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012962 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12964 as explained at the top of this document.
12965
12966 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12967 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12968 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12969 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12970 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12971 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12972 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012973 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12974 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12975 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12976 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012977 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012978 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12979 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012980
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012981 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12982 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12983 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12984 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12985 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012986 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012987
12988 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12989 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012990 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012991 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12992 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12993
12994 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012995 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12996 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12997 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012998
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012999 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013000 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013001
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013002
13003timeout queue <timeout>
13004 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13006 yes | no | yes | yes
13007 Arguments :
13008 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13009 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13010 as explained at the top of this document.
13011
13012 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13013 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13014 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13015 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13016 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13017
13018 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13019 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13020 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13021 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13022
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013023 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013024
13025
13026timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013027 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13029 yes | no | yes | yes
13030 Arguments :
13031 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13032 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13033 as explained at the top of this document.
13034
13035 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13036 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13037 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13038 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13039 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13040 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13041 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13042
13043 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13044 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13045 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13046 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13047 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013048 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013049 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013050 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13051 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013052 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13053 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013054
13055 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13056 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13057 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13058 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013059 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013060 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13061
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013062 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013063
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013064
13065timeout server-fin <timeout>
13066 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13068 yes | no | yes | yes
13069 Arguments :
13070 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13071 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13072 as explained at the top of this document.
13073
13074 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13075 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13076 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13077 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13078 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13079 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13080 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13081 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13082 situations, it should not be needed.
13083
13084 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13085 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13086 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13087
13088 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13089
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013090
13091timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013092 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13094 yes | yes | yes | yes
13095 Arguments :
13096 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13097 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13098 as explained at the top of this document.
13099
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013100 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13101 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13102 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013103
13104 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13105 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13106 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13107 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013108 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013109
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013110 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013111
13112
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013113timeout tunnel <timeout>
13114 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13116 yes | no | yes | yes
13117 Arguments :
13118 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13119 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13120 as explained at the top of this document.
13121
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013122 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013123 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13124 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13125 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013126 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13127 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013128 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13129 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13130 specified.
13131
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013132 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13133 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13134 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13135 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13136 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13137 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13138 state.
13139
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013140 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13141 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13142 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13143 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013144 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013145
13146 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13147 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13148 forget about it.
13149
13150 Example :
13151 defaults http
13152 option http-server-close
13153 timeout connect 5s
13154 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013155 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013156 timeout server 30s
13157 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13158
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013159 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013160
13161
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013162transparent (deprecated)
13163 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013165 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013166 Arguments : none
13167
13168 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13169 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13170 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13171 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13172 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13173 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13174 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13175 appropriate server.
13176
13177 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13178
13179 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13180 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13181
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013182 See also: "option transparent"
13183
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013184unique-id-format <string>
13185 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13187 yes | yes | yes | no
13188 Arguments :
13189 <string> is a log-format string.
13190
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013191 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13192 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13193 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13194 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013195
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013196 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013197 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013198 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13199 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13200 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13201 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13202 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13203 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013205 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13206 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013207
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013208 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013209
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013210 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013211
13212 will generate:
13213
13214 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13215
13216 See also: "unique-id-header"
13217
13218unique-id-header <name>
13219 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13221 yes | yes | yes | no
13222 Arguments :
13223 <name> is the name of the header.
13224
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013225 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13226 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013228 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013229
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013230 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013231 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13232
13233 will generate:
13234
13235 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13236
13237 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013238
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013239use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013240 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13242 no | yes | yes | no
13243 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013244 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13245 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013246
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013247 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13248 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013249
13250 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13251 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13252 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013253 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013254 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013255 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13256 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013257
13258 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13259 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13260 assign the backend.
13261
13262 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13263 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13264 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13265 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13266 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13267 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13268
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013269 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013270 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013271 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13272 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13273 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13274
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013275 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13276 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13277 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13278 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13279 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13280 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13281 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13282 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13283 cannot be forced from the request.
13284
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013285 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013286 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13287 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13288
13289 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13290 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013291
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013292use-fcgi-app <name>
13293 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13295 no | no | yes | yes
13296 Arguments :
13297 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13298
13299 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013300
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013301use-server <server> if <condition>
13302use-server <server> unless <condition>
13303 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13305 no | no | yes | yes
13306 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013307 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13308 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013309
13310 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13311
13312 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13313 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13314 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13315
13316 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13317 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13318 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13319 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13320 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13321 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13322 matches will assign the server.
13323
13324 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13325 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13326 with the next rules until one matches.
13327
13328 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13329 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13330 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13331 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13332
13333 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13334 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13335 stripped.
13336
13337 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13338 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013339 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013340 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013341 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013342
13343 Example :
13344 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013345 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013346 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013347 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013348 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013349 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013350 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013351 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13352 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13353
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013354 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13355 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13356 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13357 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013358 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013359 and we fall back to load balancing.
13360
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013361 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013362
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013365--------------------------
13366
13367The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13368depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13369settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13370written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13371described in this section.
13372
13373
133745.1. Bind options
13375-----------------
13376
13377The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13378as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13379no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13380parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13381while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13382provided immediately after the setting name.
13383
13384The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13385
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013386accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13387 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13388 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13389 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13390 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13391 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13392 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13393 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13394 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13395 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013396 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13397 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13398 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013399
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013400accept-proxy
13401 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013402 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13403 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013404 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13405 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13406 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13407 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013408 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013409 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13410 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013411 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13412 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013413
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013414allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013415 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013416 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013417 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013418 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13419 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013420
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013421alpn <protocols>
13422 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13423 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13424 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013425 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013426 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013427 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13428 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13429 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13430 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13431 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13432 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13433 preference, like below :
13434
13435 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013436
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013437backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013438 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013439 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13440
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013441curves <curves>
13442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13443 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13444 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13445 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13446 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13447 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13448
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013449ecdhe <named curve>
13450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013451 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13452 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013453
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013454ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13456 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13457 client's certificate.
13458
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013459ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13461 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13462 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13463 error is ignored.
13464
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013465ca-sign-file <cafile>
13466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13467 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13468 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13469 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13470 'generate-certificates' for details.
13471
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013472ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13474 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13475 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13476 'generate-certificates' for details.
13477
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013478ca-verify-file <cafile>
13479 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13480 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13481 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13482 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13483 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13484
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013485ciphers <ciphers>
13486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13487 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013488 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013489 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013490 information and recommendations see e.g.
13491 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13492 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13493 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13494
13495ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13497 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13498 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13499 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013500 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13501 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013502
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013503crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13505 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013506 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13507 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013508
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013509crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013510 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13511 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13512 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13513 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13514 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013515 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13516 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013517
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013518 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13519 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13520
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013521 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13522 are loaded.
13523
13524 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013525 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13526 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13527 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13528 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13529 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13530 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13531 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013532 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013533
13534 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13535 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13536 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13537 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013538 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13539 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013540
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013541 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013543 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013544 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13546 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013547 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13548 clients).
13549
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013550 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013551 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13552 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13553 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13554 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13555 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13556 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13557 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13558 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13559 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13560 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13561 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13562 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013564 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013565 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13566 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13567 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13568 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13569
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013570 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13571 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13572 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13573 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013574
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013575 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13576 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13577 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013578
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013579crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013581 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013582 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013583 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013584
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013585crt-list <file>
13586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013587 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13588 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013589
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013590 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13591
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013592 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13593 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13594 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13595 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13596 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013597
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013598 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013599 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13600 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13601 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13602 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13603 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013604 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13605 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13606 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013607
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013608 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13609 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13610 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013611
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013612 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13613
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013614 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013615 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013616 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13617 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13618 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13619 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13620 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13621 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013622
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013623 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013624 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013625 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013626 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013627 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013628 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013629
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013630defer-accept
13631 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13632 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13633 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013634 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013635 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13636 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13637 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13638 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13639 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13640 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13641 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13642
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013643expose-fd listeners
13644 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13645 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013646 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13647 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013648 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013649
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013650force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013651 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013652 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013653 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013654 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013655
13656force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013657 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013658 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013660
13661force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013663 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013665
13666force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013668 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013669 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013670
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013671force-tlsv13
13672 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13673 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013675
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013676generate-certificates
13677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13678 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13679 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13680 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13681 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13682 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13683 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13684 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13685 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13686 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13687 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13688
13689 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13690 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013691 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013692 certificate is used many times.
13693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013694gid <gid>
13695 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13696 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13697 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13698 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13699 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13700
13701group <group>
13702 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13703 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13704 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13705 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13706 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13707
13708id <id>
13709 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13710 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13711 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13712 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13713
13714interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013715 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13716 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13717 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13718 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13719 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13720 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013721 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13722 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13723 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13724 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13725 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13726 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013727
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013728level <level>
13729 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13730 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13731 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013732 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013733 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13734 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13735 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013736 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013737 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013738 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013739 all counters).
13740
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013741severity-output <format>
13742 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13743 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13744 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13745 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13746 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13747 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13748 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13749 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13750 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13751 rfc5424 convention.
13752
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013753maxconn <maxconn>
13754 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13755 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13756 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13757 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13758 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13759 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13760 eat all memory.
13761
13762mode <mode>
13763 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13764 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13765 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13766 UNIX sockets.
13767
13768mss <maxseg>
13769 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13770 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13771 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13772 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13773 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13774 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13775 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13776 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13777 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13778 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13779 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13780
13781name <name>
13782 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13783 page.
13784
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013785namespace <name>
13786 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13787 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13788 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13789 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013791nice <nice>
13792 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13793 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13794 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13795 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13796 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13797 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13798 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13799 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13800 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13801 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13802 one for an RDP socket.
13803
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013804no-ca-names
13805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13806 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013807 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013808
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013809no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013811 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013812 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013813 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013814 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13815 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013816
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013817no-tls-tickets
13818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13819 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13820 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013821 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13822 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013823 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13824 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13825 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013826
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013827no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013829 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013830 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013831 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013832 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13833 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013834
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013835no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013837 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013838 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013839 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013840 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13841 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013842
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013843no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013845 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013846 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013847 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13849 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013850
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013851no-tlsv13
13852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13853 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13854 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13855 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013856 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13857 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013858
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013859npn <protocols>
13860 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13861 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13862 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013863 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013864 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013865 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13866 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13867 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13868 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13869 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013870
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013871prefer-client-ciphers
13872 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13873 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13874 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013875 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13876 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13877 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013878
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013879process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013880 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13881 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13882 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13883 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13884 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13885 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013886
13887 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13888
13889 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013890 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13891 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13892 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13893 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13894 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013895
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013896proto <name>
13897 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13898 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13899 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013900 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13901 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13902
13903 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13904 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13905 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13906 also reported (flag=HTX).
13907
13908 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13909 a bind line :
13910
13911 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13912 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13913 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13914
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013915 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013916 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013917 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013918 h2" on the bind line.
13919
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013920ssl
13921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013922 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013923 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13924 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013925 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13926 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013927
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013928ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13929 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013930 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13931 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13932 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013933 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13934
13935ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013936 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13937 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13938 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13939 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013940
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013941strict-sni
13942 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13943 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13944 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13945 See the "crt" option for more information.
13946
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013947tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013948 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013949 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013950 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013951 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013952 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13953 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13954 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13955 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13956 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13957 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13958 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13959
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013960tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013961 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013962 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13963 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13964 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13965 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13966 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13967 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13968 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013969 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13970 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13971 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013972
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013973tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13974 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013975 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13976 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13977 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13978 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13979 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13980 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13981 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13982 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13983 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13984 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013985 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13986 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13987
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013988transparent
13989 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13990 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13991 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13992 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13993 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13994 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13995 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13996 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13997 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13998 so check for support with your vendor.
13999
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014000v4v6
14001 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14002 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14003 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14004 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014005 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014006
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014007v6only
14008 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14009 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14010 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014011 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14012 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014013
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014014uid <uid>
14015 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14016 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14017 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14018 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14019 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14020
14021user <user>
14022 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14023 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14024 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14025 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14026 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14027
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014028verify [none|optional|required]
14029 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14030 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14031 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14032 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14033 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014034 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14035 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14036 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14037 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140395.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014040------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014042The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14043which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14044arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14045settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14046after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14047Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14048address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014050 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014051 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014052
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014053Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14054keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014056The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014057
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014058addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014059 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014060 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14061 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14062 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14063 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14064 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014065
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014066agent-check
14067 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014068 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014069 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14070 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14071 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014072
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014073 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014074 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014075 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014076 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14077 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014078
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014079 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14080 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14081 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14082 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14083 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014084
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014085 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014086 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014087
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014088 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14089 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14090 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014091
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014092 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14093 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14094 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014095
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014096 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014097 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14098 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14099 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14100 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014101 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014102 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014103
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014104 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14105 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014106
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014107 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14108 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14109 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14110 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14111 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14112 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14113 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14114 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14115 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014116
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014117 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14118 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014119 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14120 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14121 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014122 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014123
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014124 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014125 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014126
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014127agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014128 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014129 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14130 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14131 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14132 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14133
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014134agent-inter <delay>
14135 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14136 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14137
14138 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14139 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14140 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14141 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14142 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14143 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14144 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14145 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14146 of backends use the same servers.
14147
14148 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14149
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014150agent-addr <addr>
14151 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14152
14153 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014154 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014155 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14156 hostname, it will be resolved.
14157
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014158agent-port <port>
14159 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14160
14161 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14162
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014163allow-0rtt
14164 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014165 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14166 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014167
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014168alpn <protocols>
14169 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14170 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14171 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014172 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014173 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14174 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14175 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14176 now obsolete NPN extension.
14177 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14178 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14179
14180 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014182backup
14183 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14184 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14185 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14186 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014187 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14188 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014189
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014190ca-file <cafile>
14191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14192 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14193 server's certificate.
14194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014195check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014196 This option enables health checks on a server:
14197 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14198 considered available.
14199 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14200 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14201 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14202 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14203 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14204 set.
14205 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14206 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14207 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14208 exchanges succeed.
14209
14210 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14211 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14212 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14213 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14214 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014215 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014216 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14217
14218 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14219 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14220
14221 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14222 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14223
14224 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14225 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14226 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14227 available.
14228
14229 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14230 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14231 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14232
14233 Example:
14234 # simple tcp check
14235 backend foo
14236 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14237 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14238 backend foo
14239 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14240 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14241 backend foo
14242 option tcp-check
14243 tcp-check connect
14244 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014245
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014246check-send-proxy
14247 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14248 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14249 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14250 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14251 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14252 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14253 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14254
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014255check-alpn <protocols>
14256 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14257 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14258 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14259
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014260check-proto <name>
14261 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14262 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14263 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014264 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14265 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14266
14267 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14268 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14269 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14270 also reported (flag=HTX).
14271
14272 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14273 directive on a server line:
14274
14275 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14276 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14277 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14278 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14279
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014280 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014281 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14282 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14283
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014284check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014285 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014286 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14287 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014288
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014289check-ssl
14290 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14291 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14292 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14293 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014294 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014295 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14296 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014297 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014298 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14299 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014300
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014301check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014302 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014303 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14304 for normal traffic.
14305
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014306ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14308 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14309 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014310 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14311 information and recommendations see e.g.
14312 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14313 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14314 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014315
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014316ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14318 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14319 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14320 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014321 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14322 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14323 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014325cookie <value>
14326 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14327 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14328 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14329 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14330 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14331 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14332 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14333
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014334crl-file <crlfile>
14335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14336 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14337 to verify server's certificate.
14338
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014339crt <cert>
14340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14341 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14342 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14343 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14344 certificate request.
14345
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014346 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14347 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14348 option is set accordingly).
14349
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014350disabled
14351 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14352 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14353 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14354 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14355 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014356 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014357
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014358enabled
14359 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14360 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14361 default value.
14362 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14363 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014365error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014366 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14367 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14368 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014370 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014372fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14374 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14375 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14376
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014377force-sslv3
14378 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14379 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014380 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014381 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014382
14383force-tlsv10
14384 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014385 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014386 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014387
14388force-tlsv11
14389 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014390 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014391 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014392
14393force-tlsv12
14394 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014395 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014396 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014397
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014398force-tlsv13
14399 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14400 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014403id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014404 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14405 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14406 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014407
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014408init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14409 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14410 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014411 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014412 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14413 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14414 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14415 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14416 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14417 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14418 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14419 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14420 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014422 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14423 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14424 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14425 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14426 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14427 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014428 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014429
14430 Example:
14431 defaults
14432 # never fail on address resolution
14433 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014435inter <delay>
14436fastinter <delay>
14437downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014438 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14439 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14440 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14441 between checks depending on the server state :
14442
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014443 Server state | Interval used
14444 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14445 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14446 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14447 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14448 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14449 or yet unchecked. |
14450 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14451 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14452 | "inter" otherwise.
14453 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014455 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14456 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14457 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14458 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014459 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14460 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14461 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14462 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14463 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014464
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014465log-proto <logproto>
14466 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14467 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14468 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14469 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014471maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014472 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14473 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014474 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14475 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014476 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14477 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14478 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14479 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14480
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014481 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14482 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14483 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14484 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14485 than 50 concurrent requests.
14486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014487maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014488 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14489 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14490 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14491 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014492 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14493 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14494 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14495 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14496 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14497 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14498 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014499
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014500max-reuse <count>
14501 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14502 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14503 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14504 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14505 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14506 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14507 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14508 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014510minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014511 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14512 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14513 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14514 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14515 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14516 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014517 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014518 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014519
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014520namespace <name>
14521 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14522 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14523 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14524 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14525
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014526no-agent-check
14527 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14528 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14529 default value.
14530 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14531 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14532
14533no-backup
14534 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14535 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14536 default value.
14537 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14538 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14539
14540no-check
14541 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14542 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14543 default value.
14544 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14545 "default-server" "check" setting.
14546
14547no-check-ssl
14548 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14549 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14550 default value.
14551 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14552 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14553
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014554no-send-proxy
14555 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14556 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14557 default value.
14558 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14559 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14560
14561no-send-proxy-v2
14562 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14563 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14564 default value.
14565 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14566 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14567
14568no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14569 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14570 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14571 default value.
14572 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14573 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14574
14575no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14576 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14577 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14578 default value.
14579 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14580 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14581
14582no-ssl
14583 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14584 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14585 default value.
14586 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14587 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14588
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014589 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14590 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14591 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14592
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014593no-ssl-reuse
14594 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14595 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14596 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14597 and for paranoid users.
14598
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014599no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014600 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14601 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014602 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014603
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014604 Supported in default-server: No
14605
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014606no-tls-tickets
14607 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14608 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14609 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014610 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14611 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014612 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14613 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14614 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014615 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014616
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014617no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014618 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014619 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14620 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014621 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14622 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014623 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014624
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014625 Supported in default-server: No
14626
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014627no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014628 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014629 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14630 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014631 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14632 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014633 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014634
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014635 Supported in default-server: No
14636
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014637no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014638 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014639 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14640 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014641 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14642 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014643 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014644
14645 Supported in default-server: No
14646
14647no-tlsv13
14648 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14649 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14650 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14651 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14652 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014653 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014654
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014655 Supported in default-server: No
14656
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014657no-verifyhost
14658 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14659 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14660 default value.
14661 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14662 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014663
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014664no-tfo
14665 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14666 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14667 default value.
14668 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14669 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14670
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014671non-stick
14672 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14673 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14674 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14675
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014676npn <protocols>
14677 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14678 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14679 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014680 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014681 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14682 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14683 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014685observe <mode>
14686 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14687 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14688 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14689 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14690 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14691 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014692 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014693
14694 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014696on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014697 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14698 Currently, four modes are available:
14699 - fastinter: force fastinter
14700 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14701 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14702 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14703 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14704
14705 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14706
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014707on-marked-down <action>
14708 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14709 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014710 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14711 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14712 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14713 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14714 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14715 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14716 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14717 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014718
14719 Actions are disabled by default
14720
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014721on-marked-up <action>
14722 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14723 Currently one action is available:
14724 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14725 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14726 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14727 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014728 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14729 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014730 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14731 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14732
14733 Actions are disabled by default
14734
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014735pool-low-conn <max>
14736 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14737 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14738 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14739 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14740 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14741 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14742 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14743 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14744 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14745 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014746 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14747 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14748 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14749 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014750
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014751pool-max-conn <max>
14752 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14753 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14754 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14755 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14756 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14757 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14758
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014759pool-purge-delay <delay>
14760 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014761 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014762 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014764port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014765 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014766 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14767 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14768 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14769 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14770 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014771
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014772proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014773 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14774 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14775 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014776 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14777 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14778
14779 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14780 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14781 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14782 also reported (flag=HTX).
14783
14784 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14785 a server line :
14786
14787 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14788 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14789 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14790 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14791
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014792 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014793 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014795redir <prefix>
14796 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14797 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14798 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14799 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14800 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14801 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14802 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14803 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014804 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014805 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014806 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14807 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14808 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14809 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14810
14811 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014813rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014814 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14815 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14816 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14817
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014818resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14819 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14820 server.
14821
14822 Available options:
14823
14824 * allow-dup-ip
14825 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14826 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14827 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14828 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14829 For such case, simply enable this option.
14830 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14831
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014832 * ignore-weight
14833 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14834 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14835 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14836
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014837 * prevent-dup-ip
14838 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14839 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14840 same fqdn.
14841 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14842
14843 Example:
14844 backend b_myapp
14845 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14846 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14847 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14848
14849 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14850 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14851 it
14852 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14853 different address
14854
14855 Default value: not set
14856
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014857resolve-prefer <family>
14858 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14859 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14860 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14861 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14862
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014863 Default value: ipv6
14864
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014865 Example:
14866
14867 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014868
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014869resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014870 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014871 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014872 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14874 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014875 configured network, another address is selected.
14876
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014877 Example:
14878
14879 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014880
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014881resolvers <id>
14882 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14883 hostname.
14884
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014885 Example:
14886
14887 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014888
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014889 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014890
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014891send-proxy
14892 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14893 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14894 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14895 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014896 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14897 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14898 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14899 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014900 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014901 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14902 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14903 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14904 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14905 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014906 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14907 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014908
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014909send-proxy-v2
14910 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14911 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14912 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14913 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014914 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14915 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14916 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14917 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014918
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014919proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014920 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14921 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14922
14923 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14924 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14925 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14926 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14927 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14928 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14929 connection is supported).
14930 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14931 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14932 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14933 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14934 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14935 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14936 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014937
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014938send-proxy-v2-ssl
14939 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14940 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14941 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14942 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14943 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14944 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14945 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014946 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14947 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014948
14949send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14950 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14951 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14952 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14953 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14954 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14955 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14956 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14957 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014958 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14959 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014961slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014962 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14963 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14964 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14965 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14966 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14967 parameters :
14968
14969 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14970 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14971
14972 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14973 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14974 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14975 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14976
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014977 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014978 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14979 seen as failed.
14980
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014981sni <expression>
14982 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14983 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14984 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14985 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014986 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14987 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014988 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014989 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14990 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014991
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014992source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014993source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014994source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014995 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14996 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14997 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14998 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14999
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015000 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15001 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15002 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15003 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15004 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15005 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15006 server.
15007
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015008 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15009 specifying the source address without port(s).
15010
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015011ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015012 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15013 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15014 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15015 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15016 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15017 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015018 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15019 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015020
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015021ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15022 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15023 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15024 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15025
15026ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15027 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15028 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15029 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15030
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015031ssl-reuse
15032 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15033 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15034 default value.
15035 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15036 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15037
15038stick
15039 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15040 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15041 default value.
15042 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15043 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015044
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015045socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015046 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015047 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15048 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15049
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015050tcp-ut <delay>
15051 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015052 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015053 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015054 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015055 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15056 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15057 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15058 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15059 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15060 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15061 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15062 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15063 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15064
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015065tfo
15066 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15067 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15068 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15069 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015070 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015071 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015073track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015074 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15075 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15076 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15077 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015078 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15079
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015080tls-tickets
15081 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15082 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15083 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015084 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15085 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15086 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015087 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015088 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015089
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015090verify [none|required]
15091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015092 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015093 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15094 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015096 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15097 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15098 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15099 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15100 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15101 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15102 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15103 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015104
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015105verifyhost <hostname>
15106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015107 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15108 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15109 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15110 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15111 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15112 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15113 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15114 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015116weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015117 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15118 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15119 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015120 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15121 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15122 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15123 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15124 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15125 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015126
15127
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151285.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15129-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015130
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015131HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15132using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015133configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015134This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15135can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15136workload.
15137This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15138resolution at run time.
15139Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15140carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15141
15142
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151435.3.1. Global overview
15144----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015145
15146As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15147different steps of the process life:
15148
15149 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15150 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15151 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15152
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015153 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15154 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015155
15156A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15157 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15158 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15159 resolution to know this new IP.
15160
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015161When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015162HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015163SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15164from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015165will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015166will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015167
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015168A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015169 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015170 first valid response.
15171
15172 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15173 servers return an error.
15174
15175
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151765.3.2. The resolvers section
15177----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015178
15179This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015180HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15181contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015182
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015183When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15184uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15185is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15186answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15187
15188When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015189used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015190
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015191 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15192 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15193 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015194
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015195 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15196 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015197
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015198 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15199 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15200 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015201
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015202For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15203following scenarios are possible:
15204
15205 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15206 ignored
15207
15208 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15209 applied
15210
15211 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15212 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15213
15214 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15215 retries the query with a new type
15216
15217 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15218 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015219
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015220As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015221a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015222<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015223
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015224
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015225resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015226 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015227
15228A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15229
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015230accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015231 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015232 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015233 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15234 by RFC 6891)
15235
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015236 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15237 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15238 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15239 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15240 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15241 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015242
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015243nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15244 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15245 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15246 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15247 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15248 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15249 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15250 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15251 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15252 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015253 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15254
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015255parse-resolv-conf
15256 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15257 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15258 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15259
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015260hold <status> <period>
15261 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15262 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015263 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015264 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015265 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15266 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15267 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15268
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015269 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015270
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015271resolve_retries <nb>
15272 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15273 giving up.
15274 Default value: 3
15275
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015276 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15277 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15278 type.
15279
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015280timeout <event> <time>
15281 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15282 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15283 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015284 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15285 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015286 Default value: 1s
15287 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015288 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015289 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015290 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15291 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15292
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015293 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015294
15295 resolvers mydns
15296 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15297 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015298 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015299 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015300 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015301 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015302 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015303 hold other 30s
15304 hold refused 30s
15305 hold nx 30s
15306 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015307 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015308 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015309
15310
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153116. Cache
15312---------
15313
15314HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15315(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15316RAM.
15317
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015318The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15319blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015320
15321If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15322independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15323when we try to allocate a new one.
15324
15325The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15326
15327It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15328"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15329for more details.
15330
15331When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15332replaced by "<CACHE>".
15333
15334
153356.1. Limitation
15336----------------
15337
15338The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15339
15340- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015341- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15342 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15343 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015344- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15345- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015346- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15347 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15348 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015349- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15350 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015351- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15352 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15353 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015354
15355- If the request is not a GET
15356- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15357- If the request contains an Authorization header
15358
15359
153606.2. Setup
15361-----------
15362
15363To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15364the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15365
15366
153676.2.1. Cache section
15368---------------------
15369
15370cache <name>
15371 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15372 size of cache is mandatory.
15373
15374total-max-size <megabytes>
15375 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15376 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15377
15378max-object-size <bytes>
15379 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15380 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15381 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15382
15383max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015384 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015385 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15386 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15387 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15388 default.
15389
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015390process-vary <on/off>
15391 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015392 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15393 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15394 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015395 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015396
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015397max-secondary-entries <number>
15398 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15399 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15400 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15401
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015402
154036.2.2. Proxy section
15404---------------------
15405
15406http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15407 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15408 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15409 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15410 after this one.
15411
15412http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15413 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15414 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15415 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15416 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15417
15418
15419Example:
15420
15421 backend bck1
15422 mode http
15423
15424 http-request cache-use foobar
15425 http-response cache-store foobar
15426 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15427
15428 cache foobar
15429 total-max-size 4
15430 max-age 240
15431
15432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154337. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15434----------------------------------
15435
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015436HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15438The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15439these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15440but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15441data called patterns.
15442
15443
154447.1. ACL basics
15445---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015446
15447The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15448content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15449from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15450simple :
15451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015453 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15455 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15458adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015459
15460In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015463
15464This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15465Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15466and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015467an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15468conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15469as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15470are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015471
15472ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15473'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15474which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15475
15476There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15477performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15480specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15481this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015482methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15483ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484
15485Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15486 - boolean
15487 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15488 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15489 - string
15490 - data block
15491
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015492Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15493converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15494would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15495The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15496which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15497
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015498Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15499keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15500fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15501which are summarized in the table below :
15502
15503 +---------------------+-----------------+
15504 | Sample or converter | Default |
15505 | output type | matching method |
15506 +---------------------+-----------------+
15507 | boolean | bool |
15508 +---------------------+-----------------+
15509 | integer | int |
15510 +---------------------+-----------------+
15511 | ip | ip |
15512 +---------------------+-----------------+
15513 | string | str |
15514 +---------------------+-----------------+
15515 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15516 +---------------------+-----------------+
15517
15518Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15519matching method, see below.
15520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15522 - boolean
15523 - integer or integer range
15524 - IP address / network
15525 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15526 - regular expression
15527 - hex block
15528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015529The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15530
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015531 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15532 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015534 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015535 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015536 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015537 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15540read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15541if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15542lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15543will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15544beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015545a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15547exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15548
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015549The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15550parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15551ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15552a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15553check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15554
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015555The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15556socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15557file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15560loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15561
15562 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15563
15564In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15565the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15566case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15567as well.
15568
15569The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15570sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15571do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15572methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15573is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015574obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15576default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15577that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15578string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15579
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015580The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15581By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15582string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15583resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015584server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015585waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015586flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15587function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15590sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15591be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015592
15593 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15594 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15596 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15597 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15598 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015599
15600 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15601 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015603
15604 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015606
15607 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015609
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015610 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015611 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15612
15613 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15614 binary or string samples.
15615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15617 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15620 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15621 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15624 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15627 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15630 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15633 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015634 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15637 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15638 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015639
15640For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15641request, it is possible to do :
15642
15643 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15644
15645In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15646buffer, one would use the following acl :
15647
15648 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15649
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015650On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15651possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15652
15653 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15656criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15657method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15658to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15659criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15660the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015663the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15664For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15667 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15668 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15669 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015670
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015671
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015672The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15673types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15674combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15675brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15676default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678 +-------------------------------------------------+
15679 | Input sample type |
15680 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015681 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15683 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15684 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015685 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015687 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015689 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015691 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015693 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015695 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015697 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015699 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015701 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015703 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015705 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15707 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015709
15710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157117.1.1. Matching booleans
15712------------------------
15713
15714In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15715Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15716When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15717that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15718
15719Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15720return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15721"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157247.1.2. Matching integers
15725------------------------
15726
15727Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15728enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15729to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15730
15731Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15732matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15733lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015734
15735For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15736unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15737representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15738
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015739As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15740two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15741instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15742ranges and operators.
15743
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015744For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015745operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15746Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15747of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015749Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015750
15751 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15752 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15753 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15754 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15755 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015757For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015758
15759 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15760
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015761This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15762
15763 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15764
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157667.1.3. Matching strings
15767-----------------------
15768
15769String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15770different forms :
15771
15772 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015773 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015774
15775 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015776 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777
15778 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15779 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15780
15781 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15782 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15783
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015784 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15786 matches.
15787
15788 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15789 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15790 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015791
15792String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15793exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15794characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15795string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15796to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015797before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015798
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015799Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15800(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15801Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15802
15803Example:
15804 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15805 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15806
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158087.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15809---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015810
15811Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15812they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15813possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15814passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15815the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015816the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15817match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015818
15819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158207.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15821-------------------------------------
15822
15823It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15824not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15825a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15826to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15827digits may be used upper or lower case.
15828
15829Example :
15830 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15831 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15832
15833
158347.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15835---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015836
15837IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15838netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15839within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015840host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015841difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15842at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15843does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15844parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015845
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015846The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15847abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15848
15849 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15850 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15851 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15852 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15853 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15854 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15855 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15856 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15857
15858Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15859192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15860
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015861IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15862Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15863trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15864IPv6 patterns.
15865
15866HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15867following situations :
15868 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15869 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15870 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15871 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15872 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15873 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15874 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15875 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15876 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15877 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015879
158807.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15881----------------------------------
15882
15883Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15884combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15885
15886 - AND (implicit)
15887 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15888 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15895indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15898"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15899requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15900is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15901
15902 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015903 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15904 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15905 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906
15907To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15908and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15909
15910 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15911 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15912 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15913 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015915 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15917 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15918 use_backend www if host_www
15919
15920It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15921expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15922be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15923the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15924
15925 The following rule :
15926
15927 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015928 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929
15930 Can also be written that way :
15931
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015932 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933
15934It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15935to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15936simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15937sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15938good use is the following :
15939
15940 With named ACLs :
15941
15942 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15943 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15944 monitor fail if site_dead
15945
15946 With anonymous ACLs :
15947
15948 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15949
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015950See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15951keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952
15953
159547.3. Fetching samples
15955---------------------
15956
15957Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15958against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15959sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15960ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15961of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15962available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15963
15964This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15965Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15966compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15967deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15968
15969The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15970matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15971method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15972indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15973
15974As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15975when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15976mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15977the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15978ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15979
15980Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15981multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15982when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15984are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15986all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15987
15988Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15989 - name
15990 - name(arg1)
15991 - name(arg1,arg2)
15992
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015993
159947.3.1. Converters
15995-----------------
15996
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015997Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15998of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15999is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16000was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016001has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016002unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16003
16004These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16005sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16006the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016007support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016008
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016009A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16010support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16011supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16012(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16013bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016016
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001601751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16018 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16019 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16020 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16021 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16022 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16023
16024 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016025 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16026 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016027 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16028 frontend http-in
16029 bind *:8081
16030 default_backend servers
16031 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16032 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16033
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016034add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016035 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016036 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016037 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16038 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016039 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016040 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16041 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16042 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16043 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016044 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016045 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016046
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016047aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16048 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16049 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16050 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16051 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16052 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16053 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16054
16055 Example:
16056 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16057 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16058
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016059and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016060 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016061 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016062 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16063 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016064 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16068 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016069 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016070 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016071
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016072b64dec
16073 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16074 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016075 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16076 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016077
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016078base64
16079 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016080 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016081 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16082 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016083
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016084bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016085 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016086 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016087 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016088 presence of a flag).
16089
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016090bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16091 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16092 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016093 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016094
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016095concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16096 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16097 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16098 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16099 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16100 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16101 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16102 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16103 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16104 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16105 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016106 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016107 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016108 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16109 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016110
16111 Example:
16112 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16113 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16114 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016115 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016116 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16117
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016118cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016119 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16120 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016121
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016122crc32([<avalanche>])
16123 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16124 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16125 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16126 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16127 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16128 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16129 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16130 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16131 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16132 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016133 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16134
16135crc32c([<avalanche>])
16136 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16137 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16138 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16139 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16140 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16141 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16142 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16143 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016144
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016145cut_crlf
16146 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16147 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16148 updated.
16149
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016150da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016151 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16152 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16153 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16154 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016155 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016156 configuration language.
16157
16158 Example:
16159 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016160 bind *:8881
16161 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016162 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016163
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016164debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16165 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16166 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16167 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16168 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16169 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16170 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16171 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16172 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16173 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16174 printable sample types.
16175
16176 Example:
16177 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016178
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016179digest(<algorithm>)
16180 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16181 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16182
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016183 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016184 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16185
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016186div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016187 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16188 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016189 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016190 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16191 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016192 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016193 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16194 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16195 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016197 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016198 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016199
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016200djb2([<avalanche>])
16201 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16202 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16203 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16204 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16205 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16206 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16207 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016208 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16209 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016210
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016211even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016212 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016213 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16214
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016215field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16216 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16217 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16218 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16219 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16220 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16221 fields.
16222
16223 Example :
16224 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16225 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16226 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16227 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16228 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016229
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016230fix_is_valid
16231 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16232 Information eXchange):
16233
16234 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16235 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016236 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016237 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016238 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016239 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16240 checksum
16241
16242 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16243 the server can be parsed.
16244
16245 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16246 message, false if not.
16247
16248 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16249
16250 Example:
16251 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16252 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16253
16254fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16255 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16256 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16257 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16258 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016259 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016260 added.
16261
16262 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16263 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16264 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16265 fix_is_valid converter.
16266
16267 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16268
16269 Example:
16270 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16271 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16272 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16273 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16274 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16275
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016276hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016277 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016278 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016279 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016280 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016281
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016282hex2i
16283 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016284 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016285
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016286htonl
16287 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16288 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16289 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16290 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16291
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016292hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016293 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16294 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16295 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16296 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16297
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016298 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016299 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16300
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016301http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016302 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16303 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016304 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16305 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16306 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16307 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16308 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16309 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16310 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16311 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016313iif(<true>,<false>)
16314 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16315 string otherwise.
16316
16317 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016318 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016319
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016320in_table(<table>)
16321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16323 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016324 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016325 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16326
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016327ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016328 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016329 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016330 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16331 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16332 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16333 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16334 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016335
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016336json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016337 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016338 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016339 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016340 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16341 of errors:
16342 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16343 bytes, ...)
16344 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16345 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16346
16347 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16348 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16349 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16350 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16351 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16352 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016353 - "ascii" : never fails;
16354 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16355 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016356 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016357 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016358 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16359 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16360
16361 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016362 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016363
16364 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016365 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016366 capture request header user-agent len 150
16367 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016368
16369 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16370 GET / HTTP/1.0
16371 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16372
16373 Output log:
16374 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16375
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016376json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16377 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16378 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16379 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16380 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16381
16382 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16383 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16384
16385 Example:
16386 # get a integer value from the request body
16387 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16388 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16389
16390 # get a key with '.' in the name
16391 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16392 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16393
16394 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16395 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16396
16397 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16398 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16399
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016400language(<value>[,<default>])
16401 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16402 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16403 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16404 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16405 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16406 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16407 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16408 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16409 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016410 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016411 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16412 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016413
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016414 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016416 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16417 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016419 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16420 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16421 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16422 use_backend spanish if es
16423 use_backend french if fr
16424 use_backend english if en
16425 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016426
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016427length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016428 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16429 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16430 type. The result is of type integer.
16431
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016432lower
16433 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16434 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16435 type. The result is of type string.
16436
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016437ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16438 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16439 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16440 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16441 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16442 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16443 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16444
16445 Example :
16446
16447 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016448 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016449 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16450
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016451ltrim(<chars>)
16452 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16453 representation of the input sample.
16454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016455map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16456map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16457map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16458 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16459 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16460 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16461 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16462 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16463 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16464 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16465 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016467 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16468 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16469 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016470
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016471 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016472 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016473
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016474 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16476 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016478 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016480 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16482 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16484 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16486 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016488 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16490 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16492 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16493 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16494 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16495 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016496
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016497 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16498 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16499 the corresponding match text.
16500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016501 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16502 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16503 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16504 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16505 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016507 Example :
16508
16509 # this is a comment and is ignored
16510 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16511 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16512 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16513 | | | `---------- value
16514 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16515 | `---------------------------- key
16516 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16517
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016518mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016519 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16520 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016521 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016522 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016523 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016524 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16525 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16526 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16527 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016528 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016529 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016530
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016531mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016532 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16533 <packettype>.
16534 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16535 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16536 from.
16537 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16538 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16539 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16540
16541 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16542 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16543 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16544 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16545
16546 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16547 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16548 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16549 packets only):
16550 17: Session Expiry Interval
16551 33: Receive Maximum
16552 39: Maximum Packet Size
16553 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16554 25: Request Response Information
16555 23: Request Problem Information
16556 21: Authentication Method
16557 22: Authentication Data
16558 18: Will Delay Interval
16559 1: Payload Format Indicator
16560 2: Message Expiry Interval
16561 3: Content Type
16562 8: Response Topic
16563 9: Correlation Data
16564 Not supported yet:
16565 38: User Property
16566
16567 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16568 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16569 packets only):
16570 17: Session Expiry Interval
16571 33: Receive Maximum
16572 36: Maximum QoS
16573 37: Retain Available
16574 39: Maximum Packet Size
16575 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16576 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16577 31: Reason String
16578 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16579 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16580 42: Shared Subscription Available
16581 19: Server Keep Alive
16582 26: Response Information
16583 28: Server Reference
16584 21: Authentication Method
16585 22: Authentication Data
16586 Not supported yet:
16587 38: User Property
16588
16589 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16590 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16591 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16592 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16593
16594 Example:
16595
16596 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16597 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16598 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16599 if data_in_buffer
16600 # do the same as above
16601 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16602 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16603 if data_in_buffer
16604
16605mqtt_is_valid
16606 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16607
16608 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16609 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16610 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16611 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16612
16613 Example:
16614
16615 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016616 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016617
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016618mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016619 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016620 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16621 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016622 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016623 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016624 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016625 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16626 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16627 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16628 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016630 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016631
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016632nbsrv
16633 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16634 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16635 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16636 map lookup.
16637
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016638neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016639 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16640 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16641 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16642 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016643
16644not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016645 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016646 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016647 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016648 absence of a flag).
16649
16650odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016651 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016652 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16653
16654or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016655 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016656 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016657 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16658 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016659 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016660 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16661 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16663 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016665 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016666
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016667protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16668 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16669 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16670 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16671 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16672 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16673 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16674 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16675 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16676 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16677 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16678 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16679
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016680regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016681 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16682 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16683 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16684 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16685 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16686 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16687 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16688 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16689 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016690 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16691 of characters with other ones.
16692
16693 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16694 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16695 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16696 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16697 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16698 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016699
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016700 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016701
16702 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16703 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16704 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016705 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016706
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016707 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16708 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16709
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016710 # capture groups and backreferences
16711 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016712 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016713 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16714
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016715capture-req(<id>)
16716 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16717 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16718
16719 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016720 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16721 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016722
16723capture-res(<id>)
16724 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16725 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16726
16727 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016728 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16729 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016730
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016731rtrim(<chars>)
16732 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16733 of the input sample.
16734
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016735sdbm([<avalanche>])
16736 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16737 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16738 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16739 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16740 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16741 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16742 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016743 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16744 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016745
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016746secure_memcmp(<var>)
16747 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16748 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16749 match.
16750
16751 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16752 performed in constant time.
16753
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016754 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016755 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16756
16757 Example :
16758
16759 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16760 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16761 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16762 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16763
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016764set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016765 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16766 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16767 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016768 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016769 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16770 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016771 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016772 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16773 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016774 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016775 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016776
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016777sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016778 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016779 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16780
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016781sha2([<bits>])
16782 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16783 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16784
16785 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16786 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16787
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016788 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016789 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16790
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016791srv_queue
16792 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16793 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16794 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16795 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16796 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16797
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016798strcmp(<var>)
16799 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16800 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16801 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16802 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16803 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16804 shorter).
16805
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016806 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16807 strings in constant time.
16808
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016809 Example :
16810
16811 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16812 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16813 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16814
16815
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016816sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016817 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16818 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016819 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016820 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16821 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016822 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016825 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016826 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16827 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016828 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016829 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016830
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016831table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16835 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16836 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16837 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16838
16839
16840table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16843 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16844 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16845 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16846 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16847
16848table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016852 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16853 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16854
16855table_conn_cur(<table>)
16856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16859 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16860 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16861
16862table_conn_rate(<table>)
16863 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16864 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16865 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16866 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16867 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16868
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016869table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16870 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16871 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16872 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16873 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16874 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16875 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16876 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16877 data-type).
16878 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16879
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016880table_gpt0(<table>)
16881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16884 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16885 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16886
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016887table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16891 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16892 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16893 between 0 and 99.
16894 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16895 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16896 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16897 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16898
16899table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16900 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16901 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16902 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16903 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16904 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16905 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16906 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16907 value 0.
16908 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16909 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16910 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16911
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016912table_gpc0(<table>)
16913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16916 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16917 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16918
16919table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16923 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16924 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16925 sample fetch keyword.
16926
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016927table_gpc1(<table>)
16928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16931 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16932 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16933
16934table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16937 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16938 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16939 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16940 sample fetch keyword.
16941
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016942table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016946 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16947 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16948
16949table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16952 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16953 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16954 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16955 keyword.
16956
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016957table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16958 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16959 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16960 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16961 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16962 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16963
16964table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16967 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16968 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16969 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16970 keyword.
16971
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016972table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16973 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16974 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016975 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016976 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16977 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16978
16979table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16980 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16981 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16982 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16983 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16984 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16985 keyword.
16986
16987table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16988 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16989 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016990 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016991 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16992 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16993 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16994 keyword.
16995
16996table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017000 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17001 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17002 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17003 keyword.
17004
17005table_server_id(<table>)
17006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17009 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17010 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17011 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17012
17013table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017017 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17018 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17019 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17020 keyword.
17021
17022table_sess_rate(<table>)
17023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17026 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17027 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17028 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17029 keyword.
17030
17031table_trackers(<table>)
17032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17035 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17036 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17037 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17038 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17039 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17040 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17041 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17042
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017043ub64dec
17044 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17045 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17046 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17047
17048 Example:
17049 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17050 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17051
17052ub64enc
17053 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17054
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017055upper
17056 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17057 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17058 type. The result is of type string.
17059
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017060url_dec([<in_form>])
17061 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17062 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17063 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17064 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17065 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17066 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017067
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017068url_enc([<enc_type>])
17069 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17070 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17071 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17072 optional argument is here for future changes.
17073
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017074ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017075 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017076 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17077 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17078 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017079 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17080 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17081 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17082 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017083 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017084 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17085 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017086
17087 Example:
17088 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17089 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17090
17091 message Point {
17092 int32 latitude = 1;
17093 int32 longitude = 2;
17094 }
17095
17096 message PPoint {
17097 Point point = 59;
17098 }
17099
17100 message Rectangle {
17101 // One corner of the rectangle.
17102 PPoint lo = 48;
17103 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17104 PPoint hi = 49;
17105 }
17106
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017107 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17108 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17109 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017110
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017111 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17112 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017113 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017114 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17115
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017116 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017117
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017118 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017119
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017120 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17121 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17122 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017123
17124 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17125 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17126 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17127
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017128 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17129 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17130 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017131
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017132
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017133unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017134 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17135 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17136 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17137 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17138 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17139 response),
17140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17144
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017145utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17146 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17147 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17148 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17149 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17150 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17151 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17152
17153 Example :
17154
17155 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017156 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017157 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17158
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017159word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17160 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17161 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17162 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017163 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017164 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17165 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17166
17167 Example :
17168 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17169 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17170 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17171 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17172 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017173 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017174
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017175wt6([<avalanche>])
17176 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17177 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17178 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17179 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17180 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17181 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17182 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017183 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17184 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017185
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017186xor(<value>)
17187 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017188 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017189 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017190 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017191 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017192 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17193 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017194 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017195 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017197 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017198 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017199
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017200xxh3([<seed>])
17201 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17202 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17203 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17204 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17205 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17206 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17207 considered as cryptographically secure.
17208
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017209xxh32([<seed>])
17210 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17211 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17212 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17213 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17214 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17215 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17216 as cryptographically secure.
17217
17218xxh64([<seed>])
17219 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17220 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17221 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17222 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17223 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17224 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17225 as cryptographically secure.
17226
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172287.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229--------------------------------------------
17230
17231A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17232not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17233"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17234The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17235
17236always_false : boolean
17237 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17238 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17239
17240always_true : boolean
17241 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17242 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17243
17244avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017245 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17247 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17248 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17249 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17250 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17251 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17252 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17253 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17254 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17255 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17256 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17257 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17258 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017260be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017261 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17262 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17263 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17264 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017265 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17266
17267be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17269 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17270 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17271 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17272 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017273 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17274 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017275
17276 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17277 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17278 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017280be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17281 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17282 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17283 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017284 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17286 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017287
17288 Example :
17289 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17290 backend dynamic
17291 mode http
17292 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17293 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017295bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017296 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17297 of the string.
17298
17299bool(<bool>) : bool
17300 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17301 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017303connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17304 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017305 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017306 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17307 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017308
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017309 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017310 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017311 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17312
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017313 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17314 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017315
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017316 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017317 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017318 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017319 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017320 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017322 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017323
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017324 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17325 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017327 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017328
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017329cpu_calls : integer
17330 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17331 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17332 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17333 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17334 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17335 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17336
17337cpu_ns_avg : integer
17338 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17339 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17340 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17341 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17342 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17343 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17344 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17345 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17346 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17347 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17348 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17349
17350cpu_ns_tot : integer
17351 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17352 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17353 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17354 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17355 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17356 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17357 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17358 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17359 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17360 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17361 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17362 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17363 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17364
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017365date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017366 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017367
17368 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17369 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17370 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017371 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17372
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017373 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17374 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17375 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17376 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17377 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17378
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017379 Example :
17380
17381 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17382 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017383
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017384 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17385 # millisecond granularity
17386 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17387
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017388date_us : integer
17389 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17390 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17391 from the same timeval structure.
17392
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017393distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17394 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17395 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17396 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17397 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017398 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017399 list of supported tokens.
17400
17401distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17402 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17403 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17404 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17405 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017406 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017407 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17408 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17409 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17410 supported tokens.
17411
17412 Example :
17413 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17414 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17415 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17416 # send large files to the big farm
17417 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17418
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017419env(<name>) : string
17420 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17421 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17422 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17423 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17424 certain way.
17425
17426 Examples :
17427 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17428 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17429
17430 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17431 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17434 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017435 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17436 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17438 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017439 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017440 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17441 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017442
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017443fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17444 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17445 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17446 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017448fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17450 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17451 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17452 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17453 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17454 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17455 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17456 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017457
17458 Example :
17459 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17460 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17461 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17462 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17463 frontend mail
17464 bind :25
17465 mode tcp
17466 maxconn 100
17467 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17468 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17469 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17470 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017471
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017472hostname : string
17473 Returns the system hostname.
17474
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017475int(<integer>) : signed integer
17476 Returns a signed integer.
17477
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017478ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17479 Returns an ipv4.
17480
17481ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17482 Returns an ipv6.
17483
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017484lat_ns_avg : integer
17485 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17486 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17487 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17488 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17489 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17490 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17491 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17492 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17493 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017494 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17495 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17496 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17497 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17498 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17499 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017500
17501lat_ns_tot : integer
17502 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17503 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17504 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17505 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17506 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17507 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17508 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17509 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17510 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017511 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17512 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17513 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17514 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17515 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017516 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17517 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17518 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17519 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17520 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17521 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17522
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017523meth(<method>) : method
17524 Returns a method.
17525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17528 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17529 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017530 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17531 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17532 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017533
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017534prio_class : integer
17535 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17536 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17537 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17538
17539prio_offset : integer
17540 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17541 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17542 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17543 set-priority-offset".
17544
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017545proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017546 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17547 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017549queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017550 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17551 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17552 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17554 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17555 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17556 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17557 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17558
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017559rand([<range>]) : integer
17560 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17561 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17562 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17563 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17564 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17567 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17568 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17569 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17570 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17571 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017572 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17573 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17574
17575srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17576 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17577 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17578 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17579 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17580 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17581 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17582 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17583
17584 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17585 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586
17587srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17588 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17589 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17590 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017591 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17593 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17594 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17595
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017596srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17597 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17598 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17599 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17600 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17601 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17602 fetch methods.
17603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17605 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17606 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017607 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17609 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017610 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017611 overloading servers).
17612
17613 Example :
17614 # Redirect to a separate back
17615 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17616 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17617 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17618
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017619srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017620 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17621 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17622 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17623
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017624srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017625 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17626 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17627 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17628
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017629srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017630 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17631 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17632 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17633
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017634stopping : boolean
17635 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17636 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17637 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17638
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017639str(<string>) : string
17640 Returns a string.
17641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17643 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17644 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17645
17646table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17647 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17648 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17649 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17650
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017651thread : integer
17652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17653 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17654 and debugging purposes.
17655
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017656uuid([<version>]) : string
17657 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17658 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17659 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17660
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017661var(<var-name>) : undefined
17662 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017663 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17664 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017665 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017666 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17667 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017668 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017669 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17670 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017671 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017672 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675----------------------------------
17676
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017677The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17679methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17680sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17681TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017682the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17683counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017684"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17685used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17686can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17687Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17688table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17689tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17690currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017691
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017692bc_dst : ip
17693 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17694 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17695 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17696 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17697
17698bc_dst_port : integer
17699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017700 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017701
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017702bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017703 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17704 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17705 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17706
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017707bc_src : ip
17708 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017709 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017710 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17711 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17712
17713bc_src_port : integer
17714 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017715 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717be_id : integer
17718 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017719 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17720 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017722be_name : string
17723 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017724 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17725 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017726
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017727be_server_timeout : integer
17728 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17729 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17730 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17731
17732be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17733 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17734 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17735 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17736
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017737cur_server_timeout : integer
17738 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17739 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17740 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17741
17742cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17743 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17744 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17745 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747dst : ip
17748 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17749 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17750 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17751 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017752 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17753 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17754 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17755 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17756 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17757 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758
17759dst_conn : integer
17760 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17761 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17762 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17763 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17764 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17765 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17766 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17767 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017768
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017769dst_is_local : boolean
17770 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17771 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17772 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17773 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017774 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017775 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17776 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17777 it only once per connection.
17778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779dst_port : integer
17780 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17781 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17782 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17783 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17784 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17785 an HTTP header.
17786
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017787fc_http_major : integer
17788 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17789 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17790 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17791
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017792fc_pp_authority : string
17793 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17794 if any.
17795
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017796fc_pp_unique_id : string
17797 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17798 if any.
17799
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017800fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17801 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17802 header.
17803
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017804fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17805 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17806 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17807 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17808 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17809 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17810 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17811
17812fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17813 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17814 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17815 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17816 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17817 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17818 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17819
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017820fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017821 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17822 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17823 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17824 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17825
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017826fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017827 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17828 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17829 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17830 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17831
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017832fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017833 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17834 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17835 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17836 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17837
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017838fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017839 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17840 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17841 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17842 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17843
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017844fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017845 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17846 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17847 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17848 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17849
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017850fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017851 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17852 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17853 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17854 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17855
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017856fe_defbe : string
17857 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17858 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860fe_id : integer
17861 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017862 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017863 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17864
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017865fe_name : string
17866 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17867 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17868 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17869
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017870fe_client_timeout : integer
17871 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17872 current frontend.
17873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017874sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017875sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17876sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17877sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017878 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17879 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17880 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017882sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017883sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17884sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17885sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017886 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17887 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17888 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17889
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017890sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17891 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
17892 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
17893 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
17894 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17895 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
17896 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
17897 will always return zero.
17898 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17899 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017901sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017902sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17903sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17904sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017905 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17906 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017907 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17908 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17909 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017910
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017911 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017912 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17913 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017914 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17915 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17916 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017917 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17918 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17919
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017920sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17921sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17922sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17923sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17924 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17925 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17926 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17927 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17928 when a first ACL was verified.
17929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017930sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017931sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17932sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17933sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017934 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017935 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17936
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017937sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017938sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17939sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17940sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017941 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17942 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17943 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17944
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017945sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017946sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17947sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17948sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017949 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17950 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17951 See also src_conn_rate.
17952
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017953sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17954 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
17955 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
17956 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
17957 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17958 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
17959 index, zero is returned.
17960 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17961 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
17962
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017963sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017964sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17965sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17966sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017967 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017968 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017969
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017970sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17971sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17972sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17973sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17974 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17975 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17976
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017977sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17978 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
17979 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
17980 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
17981 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
17982 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
17983 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
17984 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
17985
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017986sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17987sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17988sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17989sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17990 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17991 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17992
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017993sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17994 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
17995 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
17996 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
17997 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
17998 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
17999 between 0 and 2.
18000 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18001 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18002 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18003 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18004 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18005
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018006sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018007sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18008sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18009sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018010 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18011 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18012 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018013 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18014 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18015 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018016
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018017sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18018sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18019sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18020sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18021 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18022 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18023 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18024 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18025 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18026 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18027
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018028sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018029sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18030sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18031sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018032 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018033 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18034 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018036sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018037sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18039sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018040 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18041 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18042 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18043 src_http_err_rate.
18044
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018045sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18046sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18047sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18048sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18049 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18050 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18051 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18052
18053sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18054sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18055sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18056sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18057 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18058 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18059 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18060 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18061
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018062sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018063sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18064sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18065sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018066 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018067 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18068 src_http_req_cnt.
18069
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018070sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018071sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18072sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18073sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018074 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18075 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18076 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18077 src_http_req_rate.
18078
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018079sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18080 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18081 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18082 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18083 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18084 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18085 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18086 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18087 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18088 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18089
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018090sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018091sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18092sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18093sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018094 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018095 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18096 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18097 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18098 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018099
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018100 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018101 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18102 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018103 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18104
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018105sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18106sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18107sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18108sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18109 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18110 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18111 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18112 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18113 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18114
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018115sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018116sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18117sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18118sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018119 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18120 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18121 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018122
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018123sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018124sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18125sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18126sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018127 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18128 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18129 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018131sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018132sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18133sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18134sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018135 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018136 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18137 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18138 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018139 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018140 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018142sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018143sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18144sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18145sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018146 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18147 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18148 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18149 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18150 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018151 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018152
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018153sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018154sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18155sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18156sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018157 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18158 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18159 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18160
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018161sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018162sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18163sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18164sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018165 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18166 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018167 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018168 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18169 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018170 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18171 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18172 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174so_id : integer
18175 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18176 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18177 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018178
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018179so_name : string
18180 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18181 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18182 strings instead of integers.
18183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018184src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018185 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018186 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18187 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18188 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018189 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18190 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18191 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018192 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18193 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18194 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18195 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18196 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18197 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18198 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018199
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018200 Example:
18201 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18202 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18205 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18206 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18207 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018208 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18211 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18212 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018213 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018214 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018215
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018216src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18217 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18218 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18219 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18220 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18221 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18222 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18223 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18224 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018226src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18227 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18228 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18229 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18230 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18231 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18232 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018233
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018234 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018235 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18236 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18237 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18238 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018239 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018240 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18241 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18242
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018243src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18244 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18245 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18246 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18247 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18248 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18249 was verified.
18250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018252 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018253 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018254 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018255 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018257src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018258 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018259 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18260 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018261 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18264 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18265 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18266 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018267 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018268
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018269src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18270 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18271 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18272 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18273 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18274 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18275 is returned.
18276 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18277 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18278 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018281 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018283 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018284 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018285
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018286src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18287 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18288 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18289 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18290 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18291
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018292src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18293 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18294 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18295 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18296 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18297 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18298 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18299
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018300src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18301 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18302 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18303 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18304 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18305
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018306src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18307 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18308 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18309 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18310 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18311 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18312 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18313 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18314 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18315 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18316 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018319 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018320 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18322 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018323 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18324 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18325 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018326
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018327src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18328 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18329 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18330 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18331 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18332 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18333 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18334 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018337 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018339 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018340 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018341 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18344 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18345 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18346 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18347 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018348 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018349
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018350src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18351 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18352 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018353 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018354 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18355 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18356
18357src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18358 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18359 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18360 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18361 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18362 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18363 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018366 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18368 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018369 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18372 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18373 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18374 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018375 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018376 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018377
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018378src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18379 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18380 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18381 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18382 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18383 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18384 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18385 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18386 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18389 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18390 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18391 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018392 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18394 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018395
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018396 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018397 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018398 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018399 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018400
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018401src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18402 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18403 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18404 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18405 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18406 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18407 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18408
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018409src_is_local : boolean
18410 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18411 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18412 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18413 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018414 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018415 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18416 once per connection.
18417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018419 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18420 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18421 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18422 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18423 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018425src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018426 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18427 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18428 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18429 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18430 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432src_port : integer
18433 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18434 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18435 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18436 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018439 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018440 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18441 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18442 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018443 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18446 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18447 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18448 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18449 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018450 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18453 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18454 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18455 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18456 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18457 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18458 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18459 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18460 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018461
18462 Example :
18463 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18464 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18465 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18466 listen ssh
18467 bind :22
18468 mode tcp
18469 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018470 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018471 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018472 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018474srv_id : integer
18475 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18476 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018477 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018478
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018479srv_name : string
18480 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18481 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018482 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018483
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184847.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018485----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018486
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018487The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018488closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18489when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18490usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018491future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018492
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001849351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18494 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18495 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18496 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18497 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18498 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18499
18500 Example :
18501 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18502 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18503 # the request.
18504 frontend http-in
18505 bind *:8081
18506 default_backend servers
18507 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18508 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18509
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018510ssl_bc : boolean
18511 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18512 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018513 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18514 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018515
18516ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18517 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018518 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18519 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018520
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018521ssl_bc_alpn : string
18522 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18523 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018524 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018525 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18526 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18527 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18528 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18529 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018530 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18531 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018532
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018533ssl_bc_cipher : string
18534 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018535 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18536 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018537
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018538ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18539 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18540 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18541 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018542 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018543
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018544ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18545 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18546 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018547 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18548 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018549
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018550ssl_bc_npn : string
18551 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18552 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018553 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018554 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18555 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18556 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18557 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018558 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18559 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018560
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018561ssl_bc_protocol : string
18562 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018563 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18564 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018565
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018566ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018567 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018568 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018569 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18570 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018571
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018572ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18573 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18574 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18575 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018576 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018577
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018578ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18579 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18580 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018581 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18582 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018583
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018584ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18585 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18586 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18587 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018588 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018589
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018590ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18591 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018592 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18593 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18596 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18597 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18598 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18599 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18600 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018602ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18603 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18604 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18605 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18606 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018607
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018608ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018609 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18610 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18611 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018612 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018613 does not support resumed sessions.
18614
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018615ssl_c_der : binary
18616 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18617 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18618 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018620ssl_c_err : integer
18621 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18622 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18623 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18624 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18625 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018626
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018627ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018628 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18629 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18630 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18631 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18632 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18633 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18634 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18635 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018636 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18637 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18638 LDAP v3.
18639 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18640 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018642ssl_c_key_alg : string
18643 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18644 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18645 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647ssl_c_notafter : string
18648 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18649 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18650 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018652ssl_c_notbefore : string
18653 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18654 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18655 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018656
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018657ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18659 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18660 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18661 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18662 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18663 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18664 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18665 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018666 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18667 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18668 LDAP v3.
18669 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18670 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672ssl_c_serial : binary
18673 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18674 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18675 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018677ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18678 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18679 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18680 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018681 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18682 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18683
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018684 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018685 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18688 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18689 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18690 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018692ssl_c_used : boolean
18693 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18694 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696ssl_c_verify : integer
18697 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18698 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18699 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18700 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702ssl_c_version : integer
18703 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18704 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018705
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018706ssl_f_der : binary
18707 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18708 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18709 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18710
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018711ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018712 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18713 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18714 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18715 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018716 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018717 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18718 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18719 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018720 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18721 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18722 LDAP v3.
18723 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18724 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018726ssl_f_key_alg : string
18727 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18728 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18729 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018731ssl_f_notafter : string
18732 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18733 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18734 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018736ssl_f_notbefore : string
18737 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18738 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18739 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018740
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018741ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18743 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18744 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18745 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18746 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18747 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18748 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18749 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018750 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18751 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18752 LDAP v3.
18753 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18754 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018756ssl_f_serial : binary
18757 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18758 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18759 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018760
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018761ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18762 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18763 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18764 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018766ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18767 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18768 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18769 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018771ssl_f_version : integer
18772 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18773 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18774
18775ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018776 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18777 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18778 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018780 Example :
18781 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18782 listen http-https
18783 bind :80
18784 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18785 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18786
18787ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18788 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18789 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18790
18791ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018792 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018794 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18796 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18797 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18798 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18799 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18800 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802ssl_fc_cipher : string
18803 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18804 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018805
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018806ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18807 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18808 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018809 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018810
18811ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18812 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18813 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018814 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018815
18816ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18817 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18818 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18819 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018820 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018821 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018822
18823ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18824 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18825 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018826 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018827
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018828ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18829 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18830 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18831 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18832
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018833ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18834 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18835 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18836 transport layer.
18837 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18838 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18839 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18840 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18841
18842ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18843 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18844 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18845 transport layer.
18846 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18847 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18848 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18849 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18850
18851ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18852 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18853 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18854 transport layer.
18855 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18856 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18857 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18858 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18859
18860ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18861 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18862 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18863 transport layer.
18864 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18865 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18866 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18867 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18868
18869ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18870 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18871 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18872 transport layer.
18873 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18874 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18875 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18876 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018878ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018879 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18880 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018881 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18882 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18883 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18884 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018885
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018886ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18887 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18888 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18889 wait until the handshake happened.
18890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018891ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18892 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018893 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18894 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018895 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018896 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018897
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018898ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018899 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018900 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18901 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018904 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018905 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018906 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18907 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18908 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18909 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18910 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18911 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018913ssl_fc_protocol : string
18914 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18915 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018916
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018917ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018918 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018919 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18920 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018921
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018922ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18923 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18924 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18925 transport layer.
18926 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18927 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18928 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18929 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18930
18931ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18932 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18933 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18934 transport layer.
18935 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18936 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18937 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18938 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18939
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018940ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18941 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18942 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18943 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018945ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18946 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18947 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18948 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18949 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018950
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018951ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18952 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18953 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18954 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18955 BoringSSL.
18956
18957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018958ssl_fc_sni : string
18959 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18960 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018961 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018962 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18963 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18964
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018965 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018966 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018968 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018969 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018971 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018972 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18973 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018975ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18976 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18977 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018978
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018979ssl_s_der : binary
18980 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18981 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18982 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18983
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018984ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18985 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18986 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18987 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018988 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018989 does not support resumed sessions.
18990
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018991ssl_s_key_alg : string
18992 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18993 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18994 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18995
18996ssl_s_notafter : string
18997 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18998 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18999 transport layer.
19000
19001ssl_s_notbefore : string
19002 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19003 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19004 transport layer.
19005
19006ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19007 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19008 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19009 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19010 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19011 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19012 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019013 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19014 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019015 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19016 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19017 LDAP v3.
19018 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19019 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19020
19021ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19022 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19023 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19024 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19025 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19026 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19027 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019028 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19029 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019030 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19031 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19032 LDAP v3.
19033 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19034 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19035
19036ssl_s_serial : binary
19037 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19038 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19039 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19040
19041ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19042 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19043 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19044 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19045
19046ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19047 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19048 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19049 layer.
19050
19051ssl_s_version : integer
19052 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19053 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019054
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190557.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019056------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019058Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19059sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19060only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19061For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19062be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19063can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19064sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19065for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19066content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019067
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019068Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19069 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019070 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019071 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19072 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19073 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19074 sample expression). So be careful.
19075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019076payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019077 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019078 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19079 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019081payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19082 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019083 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019084 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086req.len : integer
19087req_len : integer (deprecated)
19088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19089 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19090 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19091 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19092 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019093 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19095 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19098 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019099 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19100 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19101 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19102 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019104 ACL alternatives :
19105 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019107req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19108 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19109 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19110 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19111 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019113 ACL alternatives :
19114 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118req.proto_http : boolean
19119req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19120 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19121 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19122 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19123 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19124 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19125 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19126 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019128 Example:
19129 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19130 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19131 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019132 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19135rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19136 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19137 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19138 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19139 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19140 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19141 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19142 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019144 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19145 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19146 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19147 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19148 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19149 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019151 ACL derivatives :
19152 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019154 Example :
19155 listen tse-farm
19156 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19157 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19158 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19159 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19160 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19161 persist rdp-cookie
19162 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19163 # This is only useful makes sense if
19164 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19165 stick-table type string size 204800
19166 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19167 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19168 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19171 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19174rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19175 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19176 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19177 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19178 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180 ACL derivatives :
19181 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019182
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019183req.ssl_alpn : string
19184 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19185 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19186 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19187 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19188 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19189 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019190 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019191
19192 Examples :
19193 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19194 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19195 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019196 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019197 default_backend bk_default
19198
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019199req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19200 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19201 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019202 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19203 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19204 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19205 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19206 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019208req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19209req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19210 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19211 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19212 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19213 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19214 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19215 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19216 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019218req.ssl_sni : string
19219req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19220 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19221 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19222 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19223 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19224 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019225 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19226 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19227 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19228 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19229 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19230 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19231 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19232 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19233 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019235 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019236 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238 Examples :
19239 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19240 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19241 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019242 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019244
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019245req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19246 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19247 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19248 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19249 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19250 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19251 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19252 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19253 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19254 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019256req.ssl_ver : integer
19257req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19258 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19259 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19260 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19261 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19262 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19263 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19264 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019265 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019266 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268 ACL derivatives :
19269 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019270
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019271res.len : integer
19272 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19273 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19274 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19275 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19276 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019277 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019278 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019279 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019281res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19282 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019283 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019284 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019285 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019286 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019288res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19289 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19290 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19291 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019292 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19293 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019295 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019296
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019297res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19298rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19299 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19300 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19301 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19302 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19303 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19304 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19305 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019307wait_end : boolean
19308 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19309 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019310 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019311 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19312 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019313 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19315 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019317 Examples :
19318 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19319 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19320 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019322 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19323 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19324 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19325 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19326 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19327 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19328 tcp-request content reject
19329
19330
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193317.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019332--------------------------------------
19333
19334It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19335This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19336data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19337its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19338HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19339content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19340to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19341more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19342response are indexed.
19343
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019344Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19345 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19346 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19347 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19348 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19349 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19350 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352base : string
19353 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19354 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19355 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19356 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19357 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19358 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19359 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19360 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19361
19362 ACL derivatives :
19363 base : exact string match
19364 base_beg : prefix match
19365 base_dir : subdir match
19366 base_dom : domain match
19367 base_end : suffix match
19368 base_len : length match
19369 base_reg : regex match
19370 base_sub : substring match
19371
19372base32 : integer
19373 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19374 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19375 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019376 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19377 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19378 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019379
19380base32+src : binary
19381 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19382 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19383 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19384 per-URL counters.
19385
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019386baseq : string
19387 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19388 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19389 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19390 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19391
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019392capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19393 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19394 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19395 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19396
19397capture.req.method : string
19398 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19399 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19400 because it's allocated.
19401
19402capture.req.uri : string
19403 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19404 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19405 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19406 allocated.
19407
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019408capture.req.ver : string
19409 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19410 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19411 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19412
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019413capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19414 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19415 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19416 The first entry is an index of 0.
19417 See also: "capture response header"
19418
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019419capture.res.ver : string
19420 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19421 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19422 persistent flag.
19423
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019424req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019425 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19426 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19427 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019428
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019429req.body_param([<name>) : string
19430 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19431 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19432 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19433 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19434 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19435 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19436 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19437 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19438 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19439 given.
19440
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019441req.body_len : integer
19442 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19443 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019444 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19445 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019446
19447req.body_size : integer
19448 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019449 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19450 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019452req.cook([<name>]) : string
19453cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19454 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19455 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19456 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19457 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19458 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19459 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19460 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19461 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19462
19463 ACL derivatives :
19464 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19465 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19466 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19467 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19468 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19469 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19470 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19471 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019473req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19474cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19475 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19476 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19479cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19480 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19481 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19482 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19483 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19486 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19487 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19488 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19489 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019490 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019491 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19492 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19493 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19494 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019496hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19497 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19498 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19499 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19500 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019501 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019504 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19505 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19506 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19507 with headers such as User-Agent.
19508
19509 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19510 found.
19511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019512 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19513 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19514 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019515 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019517req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19518 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19519 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019520 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19521 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019523req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019524 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19525 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19526 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19527 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19528 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19529 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19530 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19531
19532 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19533 found.
19534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019535 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19536 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19537 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019538 with -1 being the last one.
19539
19540 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19541 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019543 ACL derivatives :
19544 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19545 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19546 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19547 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19548 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19549 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19550 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19551 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19552
19553req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19554hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19555 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19556 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019557 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19558 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19559 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19560
19561 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19562 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19563 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19564
19565 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019566
19567req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19568hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19569 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19570 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19571 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019572 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19573 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19574 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19575 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19576 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019577
19578 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19579
19580 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581
19582req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19583hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19584 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19585 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19586 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019587
19588 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19589
19590 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019591
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019592req.hdrs : string
19593 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19594 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19595 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19596 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19597
19598req.hdrs_bin : binary
19599 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19600 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19601 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19602 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19603 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19604 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19605
19606 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019607
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019608 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19609 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019611http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19612 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19613 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19614 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19615 basic auth is supported.
19616
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019617http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19618 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19619 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19620 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19621 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019622 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19623 basic auth is supported.
19624
19625 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019626 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19627 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19628 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19629 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019631http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019632 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19633 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19634 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019635
19636http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019637 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19638 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19639 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019640
19641http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019642 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19643 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19644 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019646http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019647 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19648 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19650 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652method : integer + string
19653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19654 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19655 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19656 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19657 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19658 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19659 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661 ACL derivatives :
19662 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664 Example :
19665 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19666 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19667 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669path : string
19670 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19671 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19672 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19673 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19674 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019675 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019676 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019678 ACL derivatives :
19679 path : exact string match
19680 path_beg : prefix match
19681 path_dir : subdir match
19682 path_dom : domain match
19683 path_end : suffix match
19684 path_len : length match
19685 path_reg : regex match
19686 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019687
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019688pathq : string
19689 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19690 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19691 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19692 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19693 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19694 result in both cases.
19695
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019696query : string
19697 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19698 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19699 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19700 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019701 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019702 which stops before the question mark.
19703
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019704req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19705 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19706 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19707 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19708 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710req.ver : string
19711req_ver : string (deprecated)
19712 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19713 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19714 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019716 ACL derivatives :
19717 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019718
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019719res.body : binary
19720 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19721 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019722 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19723
19724 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019725
19726res.body_len : integer
19727 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19728 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019729 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19730
19731 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019732
19733res.body_size : integer
19734 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19735 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19736 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19737 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019738 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19739
19740 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019741
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019742res.cache_hit : boolean
19743 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19744 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19745
19746res.cache_name : string
19747 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19748 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19749 empty string.
19750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019751res.comp : boolean
19752 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19753 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19754 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019756res.comp_algo : string
19757 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19758 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19759 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761res.cook([<name>]) : string
19762scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19763 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19764 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019765 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19766
19767 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019769 ACL derivatives :
19770 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019772res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19773scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19774 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19775 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019776 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19777
19778 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019780res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19781scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19782 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19783 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019784 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19785
19786 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019789 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19790 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19791
19792 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19793 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19794
19795 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19796
19797 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019799res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019800 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19801 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19802
19803 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19804 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19805
19806 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019808res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19809shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019810 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19811 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19812
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019813 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019814 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19815
19816 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818 ACL derivatives :
19819 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19820 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19821 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19822 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19823 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19824 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19825 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19826 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19827
19828res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19829shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019830 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19831 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19832
19833 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019834 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019835
19836 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019838res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19839shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019840 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19841 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19842
19843 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19844
19845 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019846
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019847res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19848 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19849 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19850 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019851 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19852
19853 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019855res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19856shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019857 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19858 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19859
19860 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19861
19862 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019863
19864res.hdrs : string
19865 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19866 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19867 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019868 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19869
19870 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019871
19872res.hdrs_bin : binary
19873 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19874 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19875 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19876 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19877 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19878 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19879 (length of 0 for both).
19880
19881 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19882
19883 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19884 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019886res.ver : string
19887resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19888 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019889 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19890
19891 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893 ACL derivatives :
19894 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019896set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19897 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19898 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019899 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019900 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019902 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19903 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905status : integer
19906 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19907 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019908 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19909
19910 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019911
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019912unique-id : string
19913 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19914 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19915 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19916 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19917 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19918 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920url : string
19921 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19922 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19923 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19924 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19925 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19926 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19927 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019929 ACL derivatives :
19930 url : exact string match
19931 url_beg : prefix match
19932 url_dir : subdir match
19933 url_dom : domain match
19934 url_end : suffix match
19935 url_len : length match
19936 url_reg : regex match
19937 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019939url_ip : ip
19940 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19941 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19942 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19943 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19944 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19945 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19946 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019948url_port : integer
19949 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19950 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19951 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19952 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019953
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019954urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19955url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019956 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19957 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019958 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19959 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19960 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19961 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019962 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19963 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019964 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19965 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019967 ACL derivatives :
19968 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19969 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19970 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19971 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19972 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19973 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19974 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19975 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019976
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019978 Example :
19979 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19980 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19981 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19982 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019983
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019984urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19986 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19987 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019988
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019989url32 : integer
19990 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19991 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19992 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19993 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19994 is an unsigned integer.
19995
19996url32+src : binary
19997 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19998 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19999 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20000
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020001
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200027.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020003---------------------------------------
20004
20005This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20006used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20007purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20008There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20009or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20010any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20011for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20012
20013internal.htx.data : integer
20014 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20015 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20016
20017internal.htx.free : integer
20018 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20019 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20020
20021internal.htx.free_data : integer
20022 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20023 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20024
20025internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020026 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20027 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20028 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020029
20030internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20031 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20032 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20033
20034internal.htx.size : integer
20035 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20036 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20037
20038internal.htx.used : integer
20039 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20040 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20041 direction.
20042
20043internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20044 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20045 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20046 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20047 of the special value :
20048 * head : The oldest inserted block
20049 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020050 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020051
20052internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20053 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20054 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20055 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20056 integer or one of the special value :
20057 * head : The oldest inserted block
20058 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020059 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020060
20061internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20062 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20063 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20064 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20065 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20066
20067 * head : The oldest inserted block
20068 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020069 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020070
20071internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20072 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20073 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20074 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20075 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20076
20077 * head : The oldest inserted block
20078 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020079 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020080
20081internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20082 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20083 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20084 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20085 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20086
20087 * head : The oldest inserted block
20088 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020089 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020090
20091internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20092 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20093 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20094 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20095 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20096
20097 * head : The oldest inserted block
20098 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020099 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020100
20101internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20102 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20103 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20104 it returns false.
20105
20106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201077.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020108---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020110Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20111every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020112order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020114ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020115---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20116FALSE always_false never match
20117HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20118HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20119HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020120HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020121HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20122HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20123HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20124HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20125LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20126METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20127METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20128METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20129METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20130METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20131METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20132METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20133METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20134RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20135REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20136TRUE always_true always match
20137WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20138---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020139
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201418. Logging
20142----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020144One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20145provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20146very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20147provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20148state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020149to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020150headers.
20151
20152In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20153about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20154send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20155
20156 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20157 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20158 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20159 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20160 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020161 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020162 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020163
20164The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20165allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20166as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20167while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20168real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20169delay.
20170
20171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201728.1. Log levels
20173---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020175TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020176source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020177HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20178in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20179track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20180syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20181about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020182
20183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201848.2. Log formats
20185----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020187HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020188and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20189slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20190options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191
20192 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20193 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20194 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20195 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20196 extents.
20197
20198 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20199 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20200 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20201 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20202 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20203
20204 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20205 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20206 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20207 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20208 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20209
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020210 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20211 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20212 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20213 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20214
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020215 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020217Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20218specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20219field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20220servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20221always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20222identifier.
20223
20224Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20225 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20226 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20227 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20228 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20229
20230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202318.2.1. Default log format
20232-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020233
20234This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20235as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20236format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20237
20238 Example :
20239 listen www
20240 mode http
20241 log global
20242 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20243
20244 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20245 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20246 (www/HTTP)
20247
20248 Field Format Extract from the example above
20249 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20250 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20251 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20252 4 'to' to
20253 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20254 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20255
20256Detailed fields description :
20257 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20258 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20259 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20260 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20261 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20262 and processed the connection.
20263 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20264
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020265In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20266"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20267connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20268
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020269It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20270will eventually disappear.
20271
20272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202738.2.2. TCP log format
20274---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020275
20276The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20277is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20278information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20279counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20280emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20281environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20282the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20283sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020284specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20285not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20286fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20287marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020288
20289 Example :
20290 frontend fnt
20291 mode tcp
20292 option tcplog
20293 log global
20294 default_backend bck
20295
20296 backend bck
20297 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20298
20299 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20300 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20301 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20302
20303 Field Format Extract from the example above
20304 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20305 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20306 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20307 4 frontend_name fnt
20308 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20309 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20310 7 bytes_read* 212
20311 8 termination_state --
20312 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20313 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20314
20315Detailed fields description :
20316 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020317 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020318 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20319 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020320 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020321 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020322 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020323
20324 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020325 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20326 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20327 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020328
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020329 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020330 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20331 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020332 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20333 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20334 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20335 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020336
20337 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20338 and processed the connection.
20339
20340 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20341 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20342 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20343 applications.
20344
20345 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20346 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20347 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20348 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20349 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20350
20351 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20352 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20353 See "Timers" below for more details.
20354
20355 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20356 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20357 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20358 "Timers" below for more details.
20359
20360 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020361 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020362 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20363 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20364 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20365 details.
20366
20367 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20368 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20369 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20370 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20371 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20372
20373 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20374 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20375 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20376 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20377 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20378 for more details.
20379
20380 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020381 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020382 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20383 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20384 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020385 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020386
20387 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20388 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20389 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20390 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20391 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20392 caused by a denial of service attack.
20393
20394 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20395 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20396 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20397 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20398 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20399 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20400 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20401 denial of service attack.
20402
20403 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20404 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20405 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20406 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20407 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20408 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20409 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20410 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20411 be processed than on other servers.
20412
20413 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20414 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20415 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20416 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020417 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020418 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20419 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20420 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20421 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20422 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20423 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20424 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20425 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20426
20427 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20428 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20429 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20430 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20431 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20432 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020433 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020434 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20435
20436 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20437 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20438 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20439 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20440 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20441 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020442 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020443 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20444 occurs.
20445
20446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204478.2.3. HTTP log format
20448----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020449
20450The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20451is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20452the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20453are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20454emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20455generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20456"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20457which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020458frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20459is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020460
20461Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20462slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20463with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20464
20465 Example :
20466 frontend http-in
20467 mode http
20468 option httplog
20469 log global
20470 default_backend bck
20471
20472 backend static
20473 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20474
20475 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20476 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20477 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020478 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020479
20480 Field Format Extract from the example above
20481 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20482 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020483 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020484 4 frontend_name http-in
20485 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020486 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020487 7 status_code 200
20488 8 bytes_read* 2750
20489 9 captured_request_cookie -
20490 10 captured_response_cookie -
20491 11 termination_state ----
20492 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20493 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20494 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20495 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20496 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020497
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020498Detailed fields description :
20499 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020500 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020501 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20502 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020503 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020504 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020505 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020506
20507 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020508 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20509 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20510 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020512 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020513 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020514
20515 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20516 and processed the connection.
20517
20518 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20519 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20520 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20521
20522 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20523 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20524 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20525 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20526 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20527 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20528
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020529 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20530 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20531 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020532 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020533 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20534 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020535 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020536 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020537
20538 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20539 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020540 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020541
20542 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20543 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020544 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20545 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020546
20547 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20548 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20549 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20550 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20551 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020552 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20553 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020554
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020555 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020556 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20557 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20558 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20559 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20560 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20561 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020562 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020563
20564 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020565 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20566 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020567
20568 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20569 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020570 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020571 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20572 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20573 overflowing.
20574
20575 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20576 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20577 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20578 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20579 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20580 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20581 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20582 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20583
20584 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20585 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20586 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20587 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20588 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20589 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20590 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20591 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20592
20593 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20594 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20595 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20596 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20597 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20598 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20599 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20600
20601 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020602 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020603 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20604 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20605 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020606 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020607 system.
20608
20609 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20610 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20611 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20612 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20613 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20614 caused by a denial of service attack.
20615
20616 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20617 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20618 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20619 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20620 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20621 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20622 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20623 denial of service attack.
20624
20625 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20626 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20627 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20628 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20629 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20630 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20631 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20632 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20633 processed than on other servers.
20634
20635 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20636 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20637 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20638 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020639 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020640 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20641 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20642 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20643 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20644 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20645 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20646 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20647 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20648
20649 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20650 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20651 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20652 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20653 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20654 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020655 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020656 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20657
20658 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20659 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20660 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20661 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20662 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20663 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020664 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020665 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20666 occurs.
20667
20668 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20669 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20670 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20671 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20672 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20673 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20674 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20675 cookies" below for more details.
20676
20677 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20678 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20679 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20680 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20681 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20682 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20683 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20684 and cookies" below for more details.
20685
20686 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20687 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20688 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20689 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20690 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20691 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20692 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20693 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20694
20695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200206968.2.4. Custom log format
20697------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020698
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020699The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020700mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020701
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020702HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020703Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20704separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20705prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20706
20707Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20708variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020709("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020710
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020711If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020712as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020713less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20714the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20715
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020716Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20717"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20718delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20719preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020720
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020721Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20722'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20723https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20724such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20725
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020726Flags are :
20727 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020728 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020729 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20730 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020731
20732 Example:
20733
20734 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20735 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20736
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020737 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20738
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020739At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20740
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020741 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20742 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020743
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020744the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020745
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020746 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20747 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20748 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020749
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020750and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20751
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020752 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20753 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020754
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020755Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20756
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020757 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020758 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020759 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20760 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20761 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020762 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20763 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20764 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020765 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020766 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020767 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020768 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020769 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020770 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20771 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020772 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020773 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020774 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020775 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020776 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020777 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020778 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020779 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20780 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20781 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20782 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20783 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020784 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020785 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020786 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020787 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020788 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020789 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20790 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020791 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20792 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20793 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020794 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020795 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20796 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020797 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020798 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20799 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20800 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020801 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020802 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020803 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20804 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20805 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20806 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020807 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020808 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020809 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020810 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020811 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020812 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020813 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20814 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20815 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020816 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020817 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20818 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020819 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020820 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20821 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020822 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020823 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020824 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020825 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020826
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020827 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020828
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020829
208308.2.5. Error log format
20831-----------------------
20832
20833When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020834protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020835By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20836"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020837will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020838logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20839
20840The format looks like this :
20841
20842 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20843 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20844 Connection error during SSL handshake
20845
20846 Field Format Extract from the example above
20847 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20848 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20849 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20850 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20851 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20852
20853These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20854failures.
20855
20856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208578.3. Advanced logging options
20858-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020859
20860Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20861just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20862options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20863for more information about their usage.
20864
20865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208668.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20867------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020868
20869It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020870HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020871commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20872monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20873ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20874
20875 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20876 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20877 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20878 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20879
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020880 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20881 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020882
20883 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20884 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20885 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20886
20887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208888.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20889----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020890
20891The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20892what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20893or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020894"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020895just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20896log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20897after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20898is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20899with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20900with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20901
20902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20904------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020905
20906Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20907for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20908"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20909retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20910raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20911a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20912file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20913you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20914"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20915
20916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209178.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20918--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020919
20920Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20921multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20922them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20923"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20924logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20925error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20926and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20927too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20928useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20929alternative.
20930
20931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209328.4. Timing events
20933------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020934
20935Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20936reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20937the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20938frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020939mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20940addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20941
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020942Timings events in HTTP mode:
20943
20944 first request 2nd request
20945 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20946 t tr t tr ...
20947 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20948 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20949 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20950 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020951 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020952 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20953
20954Timings events in TCP mode:
20955
20956 TCP session
20957 |<----------------->|
20958 t t
20959 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20960 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20961 |<------ Tt ------->|
20962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020963 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020964 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020965 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20966 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20967 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020968 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020969 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20970 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20971 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20972 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020973
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020974 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20975 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20976 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020977 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20978 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20979 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20980 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20981 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20982 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020983
20984 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20985 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20986 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20987 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20988 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20989 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20990 request typed by hand during a test.
20991
20992 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20993 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020994 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020995 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20996 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20997 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20998 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020999
21000 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21001 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21002 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21003 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21004 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21005
21006 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21007 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21008 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21009 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21010 connection never established.
21011
21012 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21013 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21014 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21015 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21016 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21017 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21018 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21019 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21020 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21021 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21022 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21023
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021024 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21025 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21026 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21027 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21028 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21029 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21030
21031 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21032
21033 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21034 "Ta" can never be negative.
21035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21037 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021038 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21039 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021040 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021042 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021043
21044 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021045 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21046 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021047
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021048 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21049 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21050 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21051 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21052 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21053 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21054 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21055 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21056
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021057These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21058protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21059that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021060due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21061"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21062that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063
21064Most common cases :
21065
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021066 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21067 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21068 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21069 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21070 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021071 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021072 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21073 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21074 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21075 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21076 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021077 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078
21079 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21080 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21081 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21082 of ms on remote networks.
21083
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021084 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21085 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21086 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021087
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021088 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21089 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021090 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021091 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21092 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21093 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21094 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21095 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21096 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021097
21098Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21099
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021100 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021101 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021102 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021104 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021105 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21106 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21107
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021108 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021109 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21110 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21111 flags.
21112
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021113 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21114 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021115 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21116 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21117 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21118 the client connection was maintained open.
21119
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021120 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021121 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021122 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021123 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21124
21125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211268.5. Session state at disconnection
21127-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021128
21129TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21130"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21132each of which has a special meaning :
21133
21134 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21135 session to terminate :
21136
21137 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21138
21139 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21140 server explicitly refused it.
21141
21142 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21143 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21144 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21145 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021146 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021147
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021148 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021149 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150
21151 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21152 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21153 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21154 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21155 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21156
21157 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21158 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21159 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21160 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21161 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21162
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021163 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021164 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21165
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021166 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021167 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21168 backup connections when going up.
21169
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021170 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021172 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21173 send or receive data.
21174
21175 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21176 send or receive data.
21177
21178 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21179 with nothing left in the buffers.
21180
21181 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021183 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021184 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21185
21186 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21187 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21188 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21189 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21190 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21191
21192 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21193 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21194
21195 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21196 server (HTTP only).
21197
21198 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21199
21200 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21201 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21202 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21203
21204 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21205 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21206 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21207
21208 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21209
21210 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21211 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21212
21213 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21214 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21215 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21216
21217 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21218 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021219 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21220 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021221
21222 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21223 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21224 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21225 another server.
21226
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021227 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021228 server.
21229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021230 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21231 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21232 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21233 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21234
21235 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21236 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21237 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21238 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21239
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021240 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21241 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21242 "use-server" rule).
21243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021244 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21245
21246 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21247 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21248
21249 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21250
21251 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21252 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21253 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21254
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021255 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21256 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021257 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021258 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21259 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021261 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21262
21263 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21264 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21265
21266 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21267
21268 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21269
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021270The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21271was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021272helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21273starvation, attacks, etc...
21274
21275The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21276alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21277easier finding and understanding.
21278
21279 Flags Reason
21280
21281 -- Normal termination.
21282
21283 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021284 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21285 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021286 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21287
21288 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21289 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021290 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21291 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021292 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21293 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021294
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021295 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21296 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021297 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021298
21299 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21300 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21301 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21302
21303 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21304 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21305 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21306 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21307 the server takes too long to respond.
21308
21309 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21310 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21311 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21312 long a time to respond.
21313
21314 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21315 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21316 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021317 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021318 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21319 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021320
21321 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21322 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21323 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21324 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21325 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021326 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021327 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21328 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21329 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21330 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21331 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21332 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21333 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21334 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021335 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021336 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21337 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21338 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021339
21340 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21341 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021342 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21343 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21344 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21345 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021346
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021347 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021348 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21349
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021350 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021351 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21352 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021353 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021354 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21355 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21356
21357 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21358 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21359 503 or 504 here.
21360
21361 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021362 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021363 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21364 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21365 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21366
21367 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21368 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021369 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021370 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021371 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021372
21373 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21374 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21375 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21376 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21377 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21378 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021379 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021380
21381 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21382 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21383 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21384 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21385 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21386 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21387 solution is to fix the application.
21388
21389 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21390 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21391 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21392 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21393 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21394 external attacks.
21395
21396 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021397 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021398 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21400 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21401
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021402 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21403 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21404 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021405 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021406 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021408 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21409 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21410 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21411 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021412 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21413 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21414 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21415 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21416 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021417
21418 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21419 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21420 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21421 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21422
21423 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21424 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21425 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21426 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21427
21428 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21429 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21430 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21431 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21432
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021433The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021434persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021435important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21436re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21437
21438 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21439
21440 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21441 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21442 set on a GET request.
21443
21444 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21445 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021446 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021447 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21448
21449 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21450 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21451 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21452
21453 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21454 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21455 already got a cookie.
21456
21457 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21458 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21459 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21460 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21461 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21462
21463 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21464 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21465 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21466
21467 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21468 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21469 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21470
21471 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21472 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21473
21474 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21475 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21476 then advertised in the response.
21477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214798.6. Non-printable characters
21480-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021481
21482In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21483consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21484converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21485prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21486being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21487escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21488is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21489'}' when logging headers.
21490
21491Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21492issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21493containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21494
21495Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21496the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21497performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21498
21499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21501---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021502
21503Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21504achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021505section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021506cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21507the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21508the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021509locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021510not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21511user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21512a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21513wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21514
21515 Examples :
21516 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21517 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21518
21519 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21520 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21521
21522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21524---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021525
21526Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21527proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21528the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21529server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21530
21531Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21532response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021533section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021534
21535It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021536time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21537appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021538are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21539and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21540follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21541request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21542in the logs.
21543
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021544As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21545frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21546an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21547
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021548 Example :
21549 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21550 listen proxy-out
21551 mode http
21552 option httplog
21553 option logasap
21554 log global
21555 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21556
21557 # log the name of the virtual server
21558 capture request header Host len 20
21559
21560 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21561 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21562
21563 # log the beginning of the referrer
21564 capture request header Referer len 20
21565
21566 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21567 capture response header Server len 20
21568
21569 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21570 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21571
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021572 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021573 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21574
21575 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21576 capture response header Via len 20
21577
21578 # log the URL location during a redirection
21579 capture response header Location len 20
21580
21581 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21584 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21585 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21586
21587 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21588 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21589 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21590 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021591 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021592
21593 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21594 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21595 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21596 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21597 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021598 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021599
21600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216018.9. Examples of logs
21602---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021603
21604These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21605them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21606reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21607
21608 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21609 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21610 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21611
21612 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21613 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21614
21615 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21616 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21617 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21618
21619 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21620 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21621
21622 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21623 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21624 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21625
21626 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021627 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021628 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21629 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21630
21631 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21632 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21633 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21634
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021635 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21636 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21637 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21638 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021639 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021640 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021641
21642 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021643 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021644
21645 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21646 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21647 Nothing was sent to any server.
21648
21649 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21650 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21651
21652 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21653 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021654 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021655 send a 408 return code to the client.
21656
21657 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21658 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21659
21660 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21661 5 seconds ("c----").
21662
21663 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21664 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021665 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021666
21667 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021668 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021669 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21670 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21671 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21672 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21673 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021674
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021675
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216769. Supported filters
21677--------------------
21678
21679Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21680accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21681unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21682
21683See also : "filter"
21684
216859.1. Trace
21686----------
21687
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021688filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021689
21690 Arguments:
21691 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21692 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21693
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021694 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021695
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021696 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021697 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21698 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21699 amount of the parsed data.
21700
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021701 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021702
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021703This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21704callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21705information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21706filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21707
21708Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21709tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21710a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21711
21712
217139.2. HTTP compression
21714---------------------
21715
21716filter compression
21717
21718The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21719keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021720when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21721fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21722done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21723explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21724filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21725listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21726order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021727
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021728See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21729 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021730
21731
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217329.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21733--------------------------------------------
21734
21735filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21736
21737 Arguments :
21738
21739 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21740 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21741 parsed.
21742
21743 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21744 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21745 part must be placed in its own scope.
21746
21747The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21748external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021749streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021750exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21751also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21752
21753SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21754the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21755
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021756For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021757"doc/SPOE.txt".
21758
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217599.4. Cache
21760----------
21761
21762filter cache <name>
21763
21764 Arguments :
21765
21766 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21767
21768The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21769"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021770cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021771other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21772case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21773is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21774filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021775listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21776order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021777
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021778See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21779 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21780
21781
217829.5. Fcgi-app
21783-------------
21784
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021785filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021786
21787 Arguments :
21788
21789 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21790
21791The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21792request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21793reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21794used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21795implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21796used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21797fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21798used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21799order.
21800
21801See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21802 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21803
21804
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218059.6. OpenTracing
21806----------------
21807
21808The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21809HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21810of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21811Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021813This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021814
21815The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21816HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21817participates in the work of HAProxy.
21818
21819filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21820
21821 Arguments :
21822
21823 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21824 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21825 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21826 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21827 OpenTracing filters.
21828
21829 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21830 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21831 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21832 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21833 filter must have its own scope defined.
21834
21835More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021836of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021837
21838
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002183910. FastCGI applications
21840-------------------------
21841
21842HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21843feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21844the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21845FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21846servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21847FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21848backend.
21849
21850HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21851application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21852connection.
21853
2185410.1. Setup
21855-----------
21856
2185710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21858--------------------------
21859
21860fcgi-app <name>
21861 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21862 document root must be defined.
21863
21864acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21865 Declare or complete an access list.
21866
21867 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21868 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21869 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21870 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21871 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21872
21873docroot <path>
21874 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21875 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21876 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21877
21878index <script-name>
21879 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21880 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21881 is an optional setting.
21882
21883 Example :
21884 index index.php
21885
21886log-stderr global
21887log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021888 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021889 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21890
21891 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21892 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21893
21894pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21895 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21896 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21897 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21898
21899 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21900 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21901 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21902 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21903
21904 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21905 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21906
21907path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021908 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021909 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21910 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21911 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21912 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21913 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21914 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21915 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021916
21917 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021918 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021919 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21920 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21921 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21922 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021923
21924 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021925 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21926 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021927
21928option get-values
21929no option get-values
21930 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21931
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021932 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021933 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21934
21935 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21936 application will accept.
21937
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021938 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21939 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021940
21941 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021942 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021943 option is disabled.
21944
21945 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21946 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21947 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21948 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21949 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21950 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21951
21952option keep-conn
21953no option keep-conn
21954 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21955 sending a response.
21956
21957 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21958 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21959
21960option max-reqs <reqs>
21961 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21962 accept.
21963
21964 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21965 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21966 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21967 to 1.
21968
21969option mpxs-conns
21970no option mpxs-conns
21971 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21972
21973 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21974 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21975
21976set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21977 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21978 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21979 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21980 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21981
21982 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21983 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21984 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21985
21986 Example :
21987 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21988 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21989
21990 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21991
21992
2199310.1.2. Proxy section
21994---------------------
21995
21996use-fcgi-app <name>
21997 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21998
21999 Arguments :
22000 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22001
22002 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22003 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22004 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22005 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22006 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22007
22008 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22009 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22010 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22011 application are evaluated.
22012
22013
2201410.1.3. Example
22015---------------
22016
22017 frontend front-http
22018 mode http
22019 bind *:80
22020 bind *:
22021
22022 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22023 default_backend back-static
22024
22025 backend back-static
22026 mode http
22027 server www A.B.C.D:80
22028
22029 backend back-dynamic
22030 mode http
22031 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22032 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22033
22034 fcgi-app php-fpm
22035 log-stderr global
22036 option keep-conn
22037
22038 docroot /var/www/my-app
22039 index index.php
22040 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22041
22042
2204310.2. Default parameters
22044------------------------
22045
22046A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22047the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022048script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022049applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22050
22051 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22052 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22053 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22054 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22055 | | |
22056 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22057 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22058 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22059 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22060 | | application. |
22061 | | |
22062 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22063 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22064 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22065 | | |
22066 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22067 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22068 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22069 | | the application's configuration. |
22070 | | |
22071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22072 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22073 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22074 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22075 | | |
22076 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22077 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22078 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22079 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22080 | | be defined. |
22081 | | |
22082 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22083 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22084 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22085 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22086 | | is not set too. |
22087 | | |
22088 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22089 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22090 | | set. |
22091 | | |
22092 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22093 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22094 | | the request. |
22095 | | |
22096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22097 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22098 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22099 | | |
22100 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22101 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22102 | | script to process the request. |
22103 | | |
22104 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22105 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22106 | | |
22107 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22108 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22109 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22110 | | |
22111 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22112 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22113 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22114 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22115 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22116 | | |
22117 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22118 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22119 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22120 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22121 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22122 | | side. |
22123 | | |
22124 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22125 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22126 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22127 | | connected to. |
22128 | | |
22129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22130 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22131 | | |
22132 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022133 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22134 | | current HAProxy version. |
22135 | | |
22136 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022137 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22138 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22139 | | |
22140 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22141
22142
2214310.3. Limitations
22144------------------
22145
22146The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22147way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22148during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22149establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22150application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22151or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22152message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22153these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22154and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22155
22156Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22157request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22158requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22159
22160About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22161into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22162fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22163"http-request" ones.
22164
22165Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22166FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22167processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22168must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22169here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022170
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022171
2217211. Address formats
22173-------------------
22174
22175Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22176address.
22177
22178This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22179The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22180of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22181equivalent is '::'.
22182
22183Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22184is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22185
22186This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22187family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22188
22189Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22190configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22191use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22192'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22193
22194Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22195socket type and the transport method.
22196
22197
2219811.1 Address family prefixes
22199----------------------------
22200
22201'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22202
22203'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22204 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22205 listening.
22206
22207'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22208 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22209 on the statement using this address, a port or
22210 a port range may or must be specified.
22211
22212'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22213 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22214 using this address, a port or a port range
22215 may or must be specified.
22216
22217'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22218 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22219 using this address, a port or a port range
22220 may or must be specified.
22221
22222'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22223 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22224 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22225 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22226 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22227 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22228
22229'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22230 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22231 start by slash '/'.
22232
22233
2223411.2 Socket type prefixes
22235-------------------------
22236
22237Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22238type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22239this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22240This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22241but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22242
22243Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22244instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22245
22246If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22247they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22248report this to the maintainers.
22249
22250'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22251 to "stream"
22252
22253'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22254 to "datagram".
22255
22256
2225711.3 Protocol prefixes
22258----------------------
22259
22260'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22261 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22262 socket type and transport method is forced to
22263 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22264 this address, a port or a port range can or
22265 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22266 of 'stream+ip@'.
22267
22268'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22269 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22270 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22271 statement using this address, a port or port
22272 range can or must be specified.
22273 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22274
22275'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22276 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22277 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22278 statement using this address, a port or port
22279 range can or must be specified.
22280 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22281
22282'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22283 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22284 socket type and transport method is forced to
22285 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22286 this address, a port or a port range can or
22287 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22288 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22289
22290'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22291 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22292 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22293 the statement using this address, a port or
22294 port range can or must be specified.
22295 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22296
22297'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22298 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22299 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22300 the statement using this address, a port or
22301 port range can or must be specified.
22302 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22303
22304'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22305 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22306 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22307
22308'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22309 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22310 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22311
22312In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22313QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022315/*
22316 * Local variables:
22317 * fill-column: 79
22318 * End:
22319 */